blob: ea6c589c4e3170a87ab952f8c81e859b80d47c79 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau33205c22020-07-07 16:35:28 +02005 version 2.3
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9d58c9b2020-10-17 10:31:50 +02007 2020/10/17
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205
2061.2. HTTP request
207-----------------
208
209First, let's consider this HTTP request :
210
211 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100212 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
214 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
215 3 User-agent: my small browser
216 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
217 5 Accept: image/png
218
219
2201.2.1. The Request line
221-----------------------
222
223Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
224
225 - a METHOD : GET
226 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
227 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
228
229All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
230which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
231followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
232is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
233desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
234the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
235
236The URI itself can have several forms :
237
238 - A "relative URI" :
239
240 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
243 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
244
245 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
246
247 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
250 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
251 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
252 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
253 must accept this form too.
254
255 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
256 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
257 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200259 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
260 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
261 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
262 other protocols too.
263
264In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
265mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
266on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
267It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
268specific to the language, framework or application in use.
269
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100270HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100271assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273
2741.2.2. The request headers
275--------------------------
276
277The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
278beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
279an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
280Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
281values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
282encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
283the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
284define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100288"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200289as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
290normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
291representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
292HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293
294The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
295that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
296is one valid form of empty line.
297
298Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
299headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
300about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
301application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
302
303Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000304 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200305 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
306 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
307 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
308
309
3101.3. HTTP response
311------------------
312
313An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
314messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
315
316 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100317 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200318 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
319 2 Content-length: 350
320 3 Content-Type: text/html
321
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200322As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
323codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
324response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100325continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
326the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
327following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
328sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
329(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
330correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
331such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
332state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
333over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
334if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
335information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339------------------------
340
341Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
342
343 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
344 - a status code : 200
345 - a reason : OK
346
347The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100348 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
349 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
350 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
351 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
352 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000354Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100355"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
357messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
358or "Authentication Required".
359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100360HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
362 Code When / reason
363 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
364 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
365 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
366 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100367 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369 400 for an invalid or too large request
370 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
371 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200372 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100373 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200374 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100375 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
376 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
378 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
379 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
382 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
383 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
384
385The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3864.2).
387
388
3891.3.2. The response headers
390---------------------------
391
392Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
393the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
394details.
395
396
3972. Configuring HAProxy
398----------------------
399
4002.1. Configuration file format
401------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200402
403HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
404
405 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
406 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
407 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
408 "frontend" and "backend".
409
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100410The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
411referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200414
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004152.2. Quoting and escaping
416-------------------------
417
418HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
419many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
420with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
421single quotes.
422
423If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
424them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
425escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
426
427Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
428
429 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
430 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
431 \\ to use a backslash
432 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
433 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
434
435Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
436the interpretation of:
437
438 space as a parameter separator
439 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
440 # hash as a comment start
441
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200442Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
443-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
444backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
445
446Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200447quoting.
448
449Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
450nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
451
452Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
453equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
454
455 Example:
456 # those are equivalents:
457 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
458 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
459 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
460 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
461 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
462
463 # those are equivalents:
464 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
465 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
466 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
467 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
468
469
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004702.3. Environment variables
471--------------------------
472
473HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
474interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
475configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
476optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
477shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200478underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
479list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
480arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
481before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
483 Example:
484
485 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
486
487 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
488
489 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
490
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200491Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
492file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
495 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
496
497* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
498 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
499 directory.
500
501* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
502
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500503* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200504 processes, separated by semicolons.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 CLI, separated by semicolons.
508
509See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200510
5112.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200512----------------
513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100514Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100515values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
516otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
517numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
518for every keyword. Supported units are :
519
520 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
521 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
522 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
523 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
524 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
525 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
526
527
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005282.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200529-------------
530
531 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
532 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
533 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
534 global
535 daemon
536 maxconn 256
537
538 defaults
539 mode http
540 timeout connect 5000ms
541 timeout client 50000ms
542 timeout server 50000ms
543
544 frontend http-in
545 bind *:80
546 default_backend servers
547
548 backend servers
549 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
550
551
552 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
553 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
554 global
555 daemon
556 maxconn 256
557
558 defaults
559 mode http
560 timeout connect 5000ms
561 timeout client 50000ms
562 timeout server 50000ms
563
564 listen http-in
565 bind *:80
566 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
567
568
569Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
570
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100571 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200572
573
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005743. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575--------------------
576
577Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
578are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
579of them have command-line equivalents.
580
581The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
582
583 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200584 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200586 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - description
590 - deviceatlas-json-file
591 - deviceatlas-log-level
592 - deviceatlas-separator
593 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900594 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - gid
596 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100597 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200598 - h1-case-adjust
599 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100600 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100601 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100602 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200603 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200604 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200605 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100606 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100608 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200609 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200610 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200611 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200612 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200614 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - presetenv
616 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - uid
618 - ulimit-n
619 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200620 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100621 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200622 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200623 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200624 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-options
627 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200628 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-server-options
630 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100631 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200632 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100633 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100634 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100635 - 51degrees-data-file
636 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200637 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200638 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200639 - wurfl-data-file
640 - wurfl-information-list
641 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100643 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100646 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200647 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200649 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100650 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100651 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100652 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200653 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200654 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200655 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200656 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657 - noepoll
658 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000659 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100661 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300662 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000663 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100664 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200665 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200666 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200667 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000668 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000669 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200670 - tune.buffers.limit
671 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200672 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200673 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100674 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200675 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200676 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200677 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200678 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100679 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200680 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200681 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200682 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200694 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
695 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200704 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100705 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200706 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100707 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200708 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200709 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100710 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200711 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100712 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200713 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
714 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
715 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100716 - tune.zlib.memlevel
717 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200720 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200721 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725------------------------------------
726
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727ca-base <dir>
728 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100729 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
730 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
731 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733chroot <jail dir>
734 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
735 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
736 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
737 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
738 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
742 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
743 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
744 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
745 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
746 set. These sets have the format
747
748 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
749
750 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
753 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
755 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
761 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
762 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
763 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100764
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100765 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
766 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
767 on the machine's word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
771 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
772 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
773 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
774 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
775 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776
777 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
781 # first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
784 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
785 # word size.
786
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100793 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
794 # and so on.
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100800 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
801 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
802 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
803
804 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
805 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
807
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100808 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
809 # and a thread range.
810 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
813
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814crt-base <dir>
815 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100816 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
817 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819daemon
820 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
821 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100822 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
823 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825deviceatlas-json-file <path>
826 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828
829deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
832
833deviceatlas-separator <char>
834 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
835 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
836
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100837deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200838 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
839 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
840 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100841
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900842external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100843 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
844 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100845 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
846 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
847 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
848 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
849 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851gid <number>
852 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
853 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
854 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100855 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
856 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100858
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100859group <group name>
860 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
861 See also "gid" and "user".
862
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100863hard-stop-after <time>
864 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
865
866 Arguments :
867 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
868 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
869 SIGUSR1 signal.
870
871 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
872 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
873 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
874
875 Example:
876 global
877 hard-stop-after 30s
878
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
880 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
881 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
882 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
883 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500884 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200885 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
886 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
887 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
888 specified in a proxy.
889
890 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
891 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
892 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
893 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
894 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
895 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
896 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
897
898 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
899 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
900 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
901 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
902 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
903
904 Example:
905 global
906 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
907
908 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
909 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
910
911h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
912 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
913 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
914 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
915 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
916 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
917 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
918 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
919 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
920
921 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
922 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
923 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
924
925 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
926 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
927
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100928insecure-fork-wanted
929 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
930 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
931 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
932 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
933 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
934 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
935 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
936 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
937 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
938 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
939 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
940 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
941 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
942 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
943 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
944 disable it.
945
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100946insecure-setuid-wanted
947 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
948 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
949 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
950 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
951 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
952 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
953 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
954 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
955 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
956 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
957 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
958 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
959 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
960 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
961
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100962issuers-chain-path <dir>
963 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
964 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
965 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
966 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
967 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
968 "issuers-chain-path".
969 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
970 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
971 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
972 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
973 will share the chain in memory.
974
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200975localpeer <name>
976 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
977 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
978 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
979 the configuration parsing.
980
981 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
982 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
983
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
985 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100986 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 configured with "log global".
989
990 <address> can be one of:
991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100992 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100993 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
994 port).
995
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100996 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
997 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
998 port).
999
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001000 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001001 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1002 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001003 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1006 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1007 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1008 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1009 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1010 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1011 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1012 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1013 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1014 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1015 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1016 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1017 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1018 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001019 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1020 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001021
1022 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1023 "fd@2", see above.
1024
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001025 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1026 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1027 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1028 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1029 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1030
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001031 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1032 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001033
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1035 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1036 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1037 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1038 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1039 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1040 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1041 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1042 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1043 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1045 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001046
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001047 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1048 one of the following :
1049
1050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1052
1053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1055
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001056 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1057 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1058 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1059 designed to be used with a local log server.
1060
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001061 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1062 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1063 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1064 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1065 logger consumes.
1066
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001067 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1068 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1069 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1070 used with a local log server.
1071
1072 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1073 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1074 designed to be used with a local log server.
1075
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001076 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1077 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1078 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1079 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1080
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001081 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1082 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1083 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1084 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1085 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1086
1087 <sample_size>
1088 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1089 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1090 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1091 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1092 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1093
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001094 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001095
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001096 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1097 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1098 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1099
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001100 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1101 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1102 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1103 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001106 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1107 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1108 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1109 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1110 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1111 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001113 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001115log-send-hostname [<string>]
1116 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1117 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1118 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1119 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1120 the logs.
1121
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001122log-tag <string>
1123 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1124 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1125 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001126 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001127
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001128lua-load <file>
1129 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1130 used multiple times.
1131
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001132lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1133 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1134 variable.
1135 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1136 to "path".
1137
1138 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1139 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1140 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1141 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1142 will be checked earlier.
1143
1144 As an example by specifying the following path:
1145
1146 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1147 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1148
1149 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1150 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1151 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1152 paths if that does not exist either.
1153
1154 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1155 documentation.
1156
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001157master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001158 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1159 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1160 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001161 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001162 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1163 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001164 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1165 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1166 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1167 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1168 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001169
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001170 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001171
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001172mworker-max-reloads <number>
1173 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001174 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001175 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1176 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1177 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1178
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001179nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001180 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1181 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1182 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001183 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1184 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001185 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1186 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1187 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001188
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001189nbthread <number>
1190 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001191 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1192 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1193 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1194 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1195 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001196 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1197 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1198 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1199 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1200 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1201 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1202 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001203
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001204pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001205 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1206 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1207 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1208 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001209
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001210pp2-never-send-local
1211 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1212 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1213 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1214 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1215 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1216 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1217 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1218 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1219 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1220 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1221 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1222
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001223presetenv <name> <value>
1224 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1225 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1226 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1227 and "unsetenv".
1228
1229resetenv [<name> ...]
1230 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1231 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1232 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1233 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1234 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1235 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1236 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1237 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1238
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001239stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001240 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1241 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1242 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1243 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1244 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1245 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001246 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001247 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1248 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1249 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1250 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001251
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001252server-state-base <directory>
1253 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001254 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1255 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001256
1257server-state-file <file>
1258 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1259 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1260 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1261 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1262 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1263 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1264 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1265 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001266 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1267 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001268
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001269setenv <name> <value>
1270 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1271 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1272 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1273 and "unsetenv".
1274
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001275set-dumpable
1276 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001277 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1278 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1279 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1280 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1281 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1282 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1283 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1284 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1285 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1286 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1287 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1288 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1289 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1290 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1291 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1292 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1293 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001294
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001295ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1297 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001298 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001299 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001300 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1301 information and recommendations see e.g.
1302 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1303 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1304 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1305 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001306
1307ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1308 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1309 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1310 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1311 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1312 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001313 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1314 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1315 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001316 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001317
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001318ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1320 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1321 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1322 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1323 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1324
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001325ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1327 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1328 keyword to see available options.
1329
1330 Example:
1331 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001332 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001333
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001334ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1335 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1336 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001337 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001338 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001339 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1340 information and recommendations see e.g.
1341 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1342 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1343 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1344 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1345 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001346
1347ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1349 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1350 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1351 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1352 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001353 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1354 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1355 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1356 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001357
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001358ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1360 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1361 keyword to see available options.
1362
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001363ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1365 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1366 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001367 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001368 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001369 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1370 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1371 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1372 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001373 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1374 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1375 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1376
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001377ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1378 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1379 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
1380 (ex: with "foobar.pem" load "foobar.pem.key"). With this option enabled,
1381 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
1382 "foobar.pem" load "foobar.key").
1383
1384 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1385 and won't try to remove them.
1386
1387 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1388
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001389ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001390 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001391 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1392 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001393
1394 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1395 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1396 optimize the startup time.
1397
1398 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1399 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1400 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1401
1402 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001403 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001404
1405 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001406 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1407
1408 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1409 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1410 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1411 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1412 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1413 bind configuration..
1414
1415 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1416 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1417 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1418 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1419 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1420 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1421 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1422 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1423
1424 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1425
1426 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1427 a cert bundle.
1428
1429 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1430 separately in several "crt".
1431
1432 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1433 since files are loading separately.
1434
1435 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1436 required to commit them.
1437
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001438 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001439 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001440
1441 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1442
1443 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1444
1445 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1446 not provided in the PEM file.
1447
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001448 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1449 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1450
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001451 The default behavior is "all".
1452
1453 Example:
1454 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1455 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1456 ssl-load-extra-files none
1457
1458 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1459
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001460ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1461 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1462 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1463 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1464
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001465ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001466 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001467 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1468 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1469 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1470 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1471 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1472 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001473 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001474
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001475stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1476 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1477 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1478 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001479 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001480 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001481
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001482 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1483 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1484 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001485
1486stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1487 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1488 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001489 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001490
1491stats maxconn <connections>
1492 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1493 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1494
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001495uid <number>
1496 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1497 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1498 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1499 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1500
1501ulimit-n <number>
1502 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1503 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1504 option.
1505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001506unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1507 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1508
1509 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1510 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1511 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1512 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1513 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1514 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1515 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1516 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1517 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1518 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1519
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001520unsetenv [<name> ...]
1521 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1522 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1523 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1524 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1525 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1526 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1527 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1528
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001529user <user name>
1530 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1531 See also "uid" and "group".
1532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001533node <name>
1534 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1535
1536 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1537 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1538 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1539 traffic.
1540
1541description <text>
1542 Add a text that describes the instance.
1543
1544 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1545 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1546 "<" and ">" characters.
1547
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100154851degrees-data-file <file path>
1549 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001550 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001551
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001552 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001553 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1554
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000155551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001556 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1557 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1558 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1559
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001560 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001561 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1562
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200156351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001564 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1565 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1566
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001567 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1568 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1569
157051degrees-cache-size <number>
1571 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1572 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1573 By default, this cache is disabled.
1574
1575 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001576 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1577
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001578wurfl-data-file <file path>
1579 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1580 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1581
1582 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1583 with USE_WURFL=1.
1584
1585wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1586 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1587 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1588 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1589
1590 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1591
1592 Valid WURFL properties are:
1593 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1594
1595 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1596 device.
1597
1598 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1599 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1600
1601 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1602 particular web request.
1603
1604 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1605 used Libwurfl API version.
1606
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001607 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1608 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1609
1610 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1611 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1612
1613 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1614
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001615 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1616 with USE_WURFL=1.
1617
1618wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1619 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1620 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1621
1622 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1623 with USE_WURFL=1.
1624
1625wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1626 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1627 thus before the chroot.
1628
1629 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1630 with USE_WURFL=1.
1631
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001632wurfl-cache-size <size>
1633 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1634 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001635 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001636 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001637
1638 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1639 with USE_WURFL=1.
1640
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001641strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001642 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1643 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1644 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1645 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1646 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001649-----------------------
1650
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001651busy-polling
1652 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1653 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1654 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1655 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1656 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1657 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1658 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1659 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1660 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1661 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1662 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1663 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1664 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1665 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1666 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1667 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1668 "poll" pollers.
1669
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001670 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1671 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1672 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1673
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001674max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1675 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1676 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1677 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1678 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1679 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1680 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1681 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1682 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1683
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001684maxconn <number>
1685 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1686 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1687 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001688 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1689 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1690 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1691 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001692 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1693 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1694 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1695 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1696 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1697 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001698
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001699maxconnrate <number>
1700 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1701 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1702 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1703 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1704 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1705 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1706 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1707 fairness.
1708
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001709maxcomprate <number>
1710 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001711 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001712 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1713 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1714 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001716 default value.
1717
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001718maxcompcpuusage <number>
1719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1723 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1724 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1725 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1726 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1727
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001728maxpipes <number>
1729 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1730 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1731 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1732 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1733 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1734 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1735
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001736maxsessrate <number>
1737 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1738 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1739 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1740 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1741 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1742 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1743 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1744 fairness.
1745
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001746maxsslconn <number>
1747 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1748 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1749 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1750 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1751 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1752 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1753 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001754 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1755 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1756 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1757 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1758 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1759 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1760 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001761
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001762maxsslrate <number>
1763 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1764 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1765 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1766 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1767 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1768 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1769 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1770 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1771 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1772 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1773
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001774maxzlibmem <number>
1775 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1776 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1777 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001778 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1779 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1780 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1781
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001782noepoll
1783 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1784 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001785 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001786
1787nokqueue
1788 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1789 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1790 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1791
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001792noevports
1793 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1794 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1795 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1796 also "nopoll".
1797
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001798nopoll
1799 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1800 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001801 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001802 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1803 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001804
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001805nosplice
1806 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001807 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001808 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001809 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001810 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1811 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1812 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1813 "option splice-response".
1814
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001815nogetaddrinfo
1816 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1817 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1818
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001819noreuseport
1820 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1821 command line argument "-dR".
1822
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001823profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1824 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1825 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1826 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1827 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001828 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001829 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1830 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1831 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1832 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1833
1834 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1835 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1836 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1837 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1838 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001839 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1840 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1841 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1842 CLI.
1843
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001844spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001845 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1846 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1847 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1848 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1849 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1850 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001852ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001853 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001854 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001855 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1856 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1857 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1858 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1859 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001860 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1861 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001862 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1863 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1864 openssl configuration file uses:
1865 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1866
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001867ssl-mode-async
1868 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001869 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001870 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1871 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1872 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001873 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001874 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001875
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001876tune.buffers.limit <number>
1877 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1878 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1879 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1880 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1881 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001883 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1884 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1885 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1886 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1887 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1888 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1889 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1890 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1891 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1892
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001893tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1894 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1895 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1896 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1897 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1898
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001899tune.bufsize <number>
1900 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1901 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1902 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1903 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1904 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1905 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1906 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001907 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1908 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1909 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001910 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001911 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1912 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1913 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001914
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001915tune.chksize <number>
1916 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1917 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1918 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1919 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1920 checks whenever possible.
1921
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001922tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1923 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1924 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1925 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1926 this value. The default value is 1.
1927
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001928tune.fail-alloc
1929 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1930 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1931 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1932 gracefully.
1933
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001934tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1935 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1936 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1937 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1938 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1939 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1940
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001941tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1942 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1943 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1944 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1945 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1946 change it.
1947
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001948tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1949 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001950 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1951 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001952 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1953 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1954 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1955 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1956 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1957
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001958tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1959 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1960 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1961 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1962 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1963 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1964 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1965 recommended not to change this value.
1966
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001967tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1968 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1969 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1970 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1971 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1972 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1973 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1974 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1975
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001976tune.http.cookielen <number>
1977 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1978 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1979 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1980 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1981 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1982 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1983 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1984 to change this value.
1985
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001986tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001987 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1988 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001989 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001990 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001991 configuration directives too.
1992 The default value is 1024.
1993
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001994tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1995 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1996 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1997 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1998 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1999 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2000 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002001 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2002 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2003 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002004
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002005tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2006 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2007 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2008 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2009 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2010 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2011 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2012 this option to "off". The default is on.
2013
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002014tune.idletimer <timeout>
2015 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2016 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2017 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2018 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2019 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2020 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002021 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002022 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002023 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2024
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002025tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2026 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2027 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2028 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2029 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2030 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2031 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2032 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2033 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2034 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2035
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002036tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2037 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002038 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002039 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2040 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002041 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002042 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2043 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2044
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002045tune.lua.maxmem
2046 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2047 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2048 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2049 memory.
2050
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002051tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2052 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002053 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2054 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002055 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002056
2057tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2058 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2059 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2060 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2061 check servers.
2062
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002063tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2064 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2065 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2066 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002068
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002069tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002070 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2071 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2072 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2073 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2074 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2075 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2076 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2077 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2078 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2079 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002080
2081tune.maxpollevents <number>
2082 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2083 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2084 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2085 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2086 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2087
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002088tune.maxrewrite <number>
2089 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2090 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2091 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2092 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2093 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2094 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2095 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2096 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2097 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2098 bufsize.
2099
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002100tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2101 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2102 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2103 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2104 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2105 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2106 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2107 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2108 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2109 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002110 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2111 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002112 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2113 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2114 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2115 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2116 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2117 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2118 setting this parameter to 0.
2119
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002120tune.pipesize <number>
2121 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2122 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2123 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2124 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2125 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2126 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2127
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002128tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2129 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2130 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2131 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2132 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2133 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2134 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002135 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002136
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002137tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2138 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2139 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2140 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2141 default is 20.
2142
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002143tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2144tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2145 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2146 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2147 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002148 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002149 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002150 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2151 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2152
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002153tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002154 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002155 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2156 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2157 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2158 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2159
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002160tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002161 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002162 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002163 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2164 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2165 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2166
2167tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2168 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2169 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2170 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2171 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2172 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2173 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2174 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2175 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2176 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002177
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002178tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2179tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2180 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2181 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2182 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002183 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002184 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002185 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2186 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2187 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2188 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2189 notifying haproxy again.
2190
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002191tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002192 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2193 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2194 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002195 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002196 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002197 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002198 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2199 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2200 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002201 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2202 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002203
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002204tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002205 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002206 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2207 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2208 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2209 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2210 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2211
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002212tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2213 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2214 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2215 performances. This is disabled by default.
2216
2217 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2218 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2219
2220 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2221
2222 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2223
2224 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2225
2226 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2227 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2228 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2229
2230 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2231 converted.
2232
2233 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2234 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2235 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2236 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2237 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2238 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2239 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002240 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2241 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002242
2243 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2244
2245 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2246 only need this line:
2247
2248 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2249
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002250tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2251 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002252 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002253 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2254 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2255 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2256 being used for too long.
2257
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002258tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2259 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2260 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2261 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2262 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2263 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2264 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2265 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2266 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2267 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2268 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002269 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002270 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002271
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002272tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2273 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2274 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2275 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2276 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002277 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002278 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2279 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002280 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2281 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002282
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002283tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2284 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2285 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2286 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2287 1000 entries.
2288
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002289tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2290 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2291 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2292 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2293
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002294tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002295tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002296tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2297tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2298tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002299 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2300 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2301 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2302 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2303 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2304 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2305 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2306 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002307
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002308 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2309 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2310 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2311 all available space is consumed.
2312 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2313 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2314 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002315
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002316tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2317 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002318 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002319 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002320 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002321 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2322
2323tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2324 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2325 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002326 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2327 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002328
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023293.3. Debugging
2330--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002331
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002332quiet
2333 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2334 line argument "-q".
2335
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002336zero-warning
2337 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2338 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2339 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2340 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2341 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2342 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2343
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010023453.4. Userlists
2346--------------
2347It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2348http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2349it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2350
2351userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002352 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002353 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2354
2355group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002356 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002357 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2358 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2359
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002360user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2361 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002362 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2363 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002364 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2365 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2366 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2367 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002368
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002369 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2370 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2371 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2372 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2373 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2374 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2375 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2376 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2377 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002378
2379 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002380 userlist L1
2381 group G1 users tiger,scott
2382 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002383
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002384 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2385 user scott insecure-password elgato
2386 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002387
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002388 userlist L2
2389 group G1
2390 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002391
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002392 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2393 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2394 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002395
2396 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002397
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002398
23993.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002400----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002401It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2402several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2403instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2404values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2405automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2406In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2407using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2408tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2409reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2410Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2411that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2412each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002413
2414peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002415 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002416 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2417
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002418bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2419 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2420 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2421
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002422disabled
2423 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2424 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2425 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2426
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002427default-bind [param*]
2428 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2429
2430default-server [param*]
2431 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2432
2433 Arguments:
2434 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2435 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2436 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2437 details.
2438
2439
2440 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2441
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002442enable
2443 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2444
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002445log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2446 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2447 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2448 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2449 more details.
2450
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002451peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002452 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2453 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002454 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2455 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2456 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2457 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2458 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002459
2460 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2461 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2462
2463 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002464 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2465 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2466 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002467
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002468 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2469 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002470
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002471 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2472 "server" keyword explanation below).
2473
2474server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002475 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002476 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2477 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2478 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2479 of this "peers" section).
2480 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2481
2482
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002483 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002484 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002485 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002486 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2487 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2488 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002489
2490 backend mybackend
2491 mode tcp
2492 balance roundrobin
2493 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2494 stick on src
2495
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002496 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2497 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002498
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002499 Example:
2500 peers mypeers
2501 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2502 default-server ssl verify none
2503 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2504 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002505
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002506
2507table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2508 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2509
2510 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2511 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002512 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002513 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2514 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2515 "stick-table" keyword).
2516
2517 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2518 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2519 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2520 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2521 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2522 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2523 of the stick-table name as follows:
2524
2525 peers mypeers
2526 peer A ...
2527 peer B ...
2528 table t1 ...
2529
2530 frontend fe1
2531 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2532
2533 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2534 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2535
2536 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2537 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2538 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2539 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2540 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2541 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2542 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2543
2544 peers mypeers
2545 peer A ...
2546 peer B ...
2547 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2548
2549 backend t1
2550 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2551
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002552 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002553 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2554 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2555
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090025563.6. Mailers
2557------------
2558It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2559If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2560in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2561
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002562mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002563 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2564 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2565
2566mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2567 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2568
2569 Example:
2570 mailers mymailers
2571 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2572 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2573
2574 backend mybackend
2575 mode tcp
2576 balance roundrobin
2577
2578 email-alert mailers mymailers
2579 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2580 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2581
2582 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2583 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2584
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002585timeout mail <time>
2586 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2587 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2588 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2589 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2590
2591 Example:
2592 mailers mymailers
2593 timeout mail 20s
2594 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002595
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025963.7. Programs
2597-------------
2598In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2599master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2600managed the same way as the workers.
2601
2602During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2603sequence as a worker:
2604
2605 - the master is re-executed
2606 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2607 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2608 instance of the program
2609
2610During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2611
2612program <name>
2613 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2614 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2615 the management guide).
2616
2617command <command> [arguments*]
2618 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2619 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2620 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2621 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2622
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002623user <user name>
2624 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2625 See also "group".
2626
2627group <group name>
2628 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2629 See also "user".
2630
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002631option start-on-reload
2632no option start-on-reload
2633 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2634 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2635 program section.
2636
2637
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010026383.8. HTTP-errors
2639----------------
2640
2641It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2642imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2643several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2644
2645http-errors <name>
2646 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2647 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2648
2649errorfile <code> <file>
2650 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2651
2652 Arguments :
2653 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002654 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2655 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002656
2657 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2658 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2659 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2660 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2661 before any chroot is performed.
2662
2663 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2664
2665 Example:
2666 http-errors website-1
2667 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2668 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2669 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2670
2671 http-errors website-2
2672 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2673 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2674 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2675
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020026763.9. Rings
2677----------
2678
2679It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2680servers or traces.
2681
2682ring <ringname>
2683 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2684
2685description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002686 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002687 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2688
2689format <format>
2690 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2691
2692 Arguments:
2693 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2694 one of the following :
2695
2696 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2697 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2698 designed to be used with a local log server.
2699
2700 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2701 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2702 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2703 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2704 is the default.
2705
2706 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2707 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2708
2709 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2710 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2711
2712 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2713 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2714 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2715 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2716 logger consumes.
2717
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002718 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2719 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2720 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2721 with a local log server.
2722
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002723 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2724 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2725 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2726 used with a local log server.
2727
2728maxlen <length>
2729 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2730 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2731 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2732
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002733server <name> <address> [param*]
2734 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2735 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2736 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2737 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2738 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2739 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2740 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2741 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2742 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002743 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2744 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002745
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002746size <size>
2747 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2748 set to BUFSIZE.
2749
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002750timeout connect <timeout>
2751 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2752
2753 Arguments :
2754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2756 as explained at the top of this document.
2757
2758timeout server <timeout>
2759 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2760
2761 Arguments :
2762 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2763 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2764 as explained at the top of this document.
2765
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002766 Example:
2767 global
2768 log ring@myring local7
2769
2770 ring myring
2771 description "My local buffer"
2772 format rfc3164
2773 maxlen 1200
2774 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002775 timeout connect 5s
2776 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002777 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002778
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020027793.10. Log forwarding
2780-------------------
2781
2782It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
2783haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
2784
2785log-forward <name>
2786 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
2787
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002788backlog <conns>
2789 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2790 on connections accept.
2791
2792bind <addr> [param*]
2793 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02002794 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
2795 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
2796 syslog protocol over TCP.
2797 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002798 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
2799
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02002800dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002801 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
2802 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
2803 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
2804 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02002805 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002806
2807log global
2808log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2809 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2810 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
2811 documentation.
2812 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
2813 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
2814 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
2815 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
2816 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
2817
2818 Example:
2819 global
2820 log stderr format iso local7
2821
2822 ring myring
2823 description "My local buffer"
2824 format rfc5424
2825 maxlen 1200
2826 size 32764
2827 timeout connect 5s
2828 timeout server 10s
2829 # syslog tcp server
2830 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
2831
2832 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002833 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
2834 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02002835 # all messages on stderr
2836 log global
2837 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
2838 log ring@myring local0
2839 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
2840 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
2841 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
2842 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
2843 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002844
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02002845maxconn <conns>
2846 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
2847 10 is the default.
2848
2849timeout client <timeout>
2850 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028524. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002854
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002855Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002856 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002857 - frontend <name>
2858 - backend <name>
2859 - listen <name>
2860
2861A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2862its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2863section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002864section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002865
2866A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2867connections.
2868
2869A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2870to forward incoming connections.
2871
2872A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2873parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2876'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2877case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2878
2879Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2880logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2881proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2882However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2883name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2884
2885Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2886and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002887bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2889modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2890arbitrary criteria.
2891
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002892In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2893a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002894the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002895
2896 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2897 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2898 between responses and new requests.
2899
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002900 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2901 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2902 client-facing connection remains open.
2903
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002904 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2905 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002906
2907The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2908frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2909following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002910weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002911
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002912 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002913
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002914 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2915 ----+-----+-----+----
2916 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2917 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002918 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2919 ----+-----+-----+----
2920 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002921
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029244.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2925--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002927The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2928limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2929they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2930limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002931marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002932option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002933and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2934with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2935specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002937
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002938 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2939------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2940acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002941backlog X X X -
2942balance X - X X
2943bind - X X -
2944bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002945capture cookie - X X -
2946capture request header - X X -
2947capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09002948clitcpka-cnt X X X -
2949clitcpka-idle X X X -
2950clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002951compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002952cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002953declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002954default-server X - X X
2955default_backend X X X -
2956description - X X X
2957disabled X X X X
2958dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002959email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002960email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002961email-alert mailers X X X X
2962email-alert myhostname X X X X
2963email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002964enabled X X X X
2965errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002966errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002967errorloc X X X X
2968errorloc302 X X X X
2969-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2970errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002971force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002972filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002973fullconn X - X X
2974grace X X X X
2975hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002976http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002977http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002978http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002979http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002980http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002981http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002982http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002983http-check set-var X - X X
2984http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002985http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002986http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002987http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002988http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002989http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002990id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002991ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002992load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002993log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002994log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002995log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002996log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002997max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002998maxconn X X X -
2999mode X X X X
3000monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003001monitor-uri X X X -
3002option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3003option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3004option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3005option allbackups (*) X - X X
3006option checkcache (*) X - X X
3007option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3008option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003009option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003010option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3011option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3013option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003014option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3015option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003016option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003017option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003018option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003019option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003020option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003021option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3022option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3023option httpchk X - X X
3024option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003025option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003026option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003027option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003028option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003029option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003030option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3031option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3032option logasap (*) X X X -
3033option mysql-check X - X X
3034option nolinger (*) X X X X
3035option originalto X X X X
3036option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003037option pgsql-check X - X X
3038option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003041option smtpchk X - X X
3042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3044option splice-request (*) X X X X
3045option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003046option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003047option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3048option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3049-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003050option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003051option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3052option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3053option tcpka X X X X
3054option tcplog X X X X
3055option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003056external-check command X - X X
3057external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003058persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3059rate-limit sessions X X X -
3060redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003061-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003062retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003063retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003064server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003065server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003066server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003067source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003068srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3069srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3070srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003071stats admin - X X X
3072stats auth X X X X
3073stats enable X X X X
3074stats hide-version X X X X
3075stats http-request - X X X
3076stats realm X X X X
3077stats refresh X X X X
3078stats scope X X X X
3079stats show-desc X X X X
3080stats show-legends X X X X
3081stats show-node X X X X
3082stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003083-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3084stick match - - X X
3085stick on - - X X
3086stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003087stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003088stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003089tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003090tcp-check connect X - X X
3091tcp-check expect X - X X
3092tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003093tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003094tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003095tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003096tcp-check set-var X - X X
3097tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003098tcp-request connection - X X -
3099tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003100tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003101tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003102tcp-response content - - X X
3103tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003104timeout check X - X X
3105timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003106timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003107timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003108timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3109timeout http-request X X X X
3110timeout queue X - X X
3111timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003112timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003113timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003114timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003115transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003116unique-id-format X X X -
3117unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003118use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003119use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003120use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003121------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3122 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003123
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031254.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3126---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
3128This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3129
3130
3131acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3132 Declare or complete an access list.
3133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3134 no | yes | yes | yes
3135 Example:
3136 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3137 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3138 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003140 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141
3142
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003143backlog <conns>
3144 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3146 yes | yes | yes | no
3147 Arguments :
3148 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3149 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003150 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003151
3152 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3153 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3154 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3155 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3156 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3157 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3158 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3159 backlog parameter.
3160
3161 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3162 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3163 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3164
3165 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3166
3167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003169balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3172 yes | no | yes | yes
3173 Arguments :
3174 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3175 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3176 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3177 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3178
3179 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3180 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3181 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3182 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003183 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003184 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003185 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3186 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3187 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3188 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3189 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3190 it, so that you don't worry.
3191
3192 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3193 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3194 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3195 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3196 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3197 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3198 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3199 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003200
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003201 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3202 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3203 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3204 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3205 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3206 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3207 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3208 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3209
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003210 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003211 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003212 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3213 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003214 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003215 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3216 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3217 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3218 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3219 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003220 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3221 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3222 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3223 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3224 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3225 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003226
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003227 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3228 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3229 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3230 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3231 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3232 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3233 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3234 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003235 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003236 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003237 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3238 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3239 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003240
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003241 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3242 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3243 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3244 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3245 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3246 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3247 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3248 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3249 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3250 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3251 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3252 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003253
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003254 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003255 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3256 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3257 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3258 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3259 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3260 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3261 URIs start with a leading "/".
3262
3263 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3264 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3265 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3266 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3267
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003268 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3269 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3270 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3271 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003273 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003274 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3275
3276 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003277 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3278 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003279 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3280 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3281 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3282 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003283 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003284 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3285 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003286
3287 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3288 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3289 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3290 server will receive the request.
3291
3292 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3293 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3294 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3295 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3296 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003297 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3298 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3299 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003300
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003301 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3302 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3303 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3304 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3305 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003307 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003308 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3309 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3310 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3311
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003312 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3313 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3314 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3315
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003316 random
3317 random(<draws>)
3318 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003319 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3320 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3321 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3322 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003323 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3324 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3325 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3326 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3327 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3328 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3329 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3330 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3331 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3332 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3333 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3334 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3335 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3336 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3337 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3338 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3339 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3340 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3341 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3342 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003343
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003344 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003345 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003346 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3347 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3348 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3349 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3350 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3351 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003352 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003353 used instead.
3354
3355 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3356 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3357 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3358 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3359
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003360 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3361 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3362 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3363
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003364 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003367 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3368 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003369
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003370 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3371 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3372 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003373
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003374 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003375 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003376 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3377 NTLM relies on.
3378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003379 Examples :
3380 balance roundrobin
3381 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003382 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003383 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3384 balance hdr(host)
3385 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003386
3387 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3388 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003390 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003391 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3392 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3393 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003394 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003395
3396 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3397 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3398 defaults to 16 kB.
3399
3400 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3401 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3402
3403 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3404 Round Robin.
3405
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003406 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003407 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3408 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3409 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3410
3411 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3412
3413 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003414 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003415 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3416 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3417 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003419 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003422bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3423bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 no | yes | yes | no
3427 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003428 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3429 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3430 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3431 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003432 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003433 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3434 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3435 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3436 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3437 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3438 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003439 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003440 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3441 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003442 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003443 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3444 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003445 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003446 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3447 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003448 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003449 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3450 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3451 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3452 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3453 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3454 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3455 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003456 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3457 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3458 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003459 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3460 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3461 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3462 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003463 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3464 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3465 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003466
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003467 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3468 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003469 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3470 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3471 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003472 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3473 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3474 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3475 the range.
3476
3477 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3478 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3479 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3480 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3481 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3482 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3483 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003484 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003485 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003486
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003487 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003488 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003489 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3490 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3491 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3492 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3493 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3494 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003496 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3497 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3498 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3499 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3502 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3503 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3504 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3505 in a frontend.
3506
3507 Example :
3508 listen http_proxy
3509 bind :80,:443
3510 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003511 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003513 listen http_https_proxy
3514 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003515 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003516
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003517 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3518 bind ipv6@:80
3519 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3520 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3521
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003522 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003523 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003524
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003525 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3526 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3527 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3528 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3529 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3530
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003531 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003532 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003533
3534
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003535bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003536 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 yes | yes | yes | yes
3539 Arguments :
3540 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3541 may be used to override a default value.
3542
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003543 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003544 option may be combined with other numbers.
3545
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003546 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003547 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3548 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3549 missing from all processes.
3550
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003551 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003552 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003553 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3554 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3555 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3556 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3557 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003558 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003559
3560 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3561 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3562 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3563 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3564 and 'even' instances.
3565
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003566 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3567 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3568 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3569 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003570
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003571 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3572 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3573
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003574 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3575 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3576 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3577
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003578 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3579 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3580
3581 Example :
3582 listen app_ip1
3583 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003584 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003585
3586 listen app_ip2
3587 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003588 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003589
3590 listen management
3591 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003592 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003593
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003594 listen management
3595 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3596 bind-process 1-4
3597
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003598 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003599
3600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601capture cookie <name> len <length>
3602 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 no | yes | yes | no
3605 Arguments :
3606 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3607 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3608 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3609 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003610 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611
3612 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3613 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3614 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3615 right if it exceeds <length>.
3616
3617 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3618 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3619 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3620 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3621
3622 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3623 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3624 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3625
3626 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3627 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3628 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003629 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3630 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3631 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
3633 Example:
3634 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3635
3636 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003637 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003638
3639
3640capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003641 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3643 no | yes | yes | no
3644 Arguments :
3645 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003646 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3648 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3649 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3650
3651 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3652 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3653 it exceeds <length>.
3654
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003655 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003656 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3657 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003658 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3659 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3660 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3661 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003662 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003663 environments to find where the request came from.
3664
3665 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3666 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3667 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3668 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003670 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3671 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3672 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3673 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3674 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003675
3676 Example:
3677 capture request header Host len 15
3678 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003679 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003681 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682 about logging.
3683
3684
3685capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003686 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3688 no | yes | yes | no
3689 Arguments :
3690 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003691 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003692 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3693 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3694 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3695
3696 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3697 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3698 it exceeds <length>.
3699
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003700 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003701 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3702 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3703 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003704 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3705 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3706 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3707 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003709 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3710 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3711 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3712 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3713 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003714
3715 Example:
3716 capture response header Content-length len 9
3717 capture response header Location len 15
3718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003719 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720 about logging.
3721
3722
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003723clitcpka-cnt <count>
3724 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
3725 the connection on the client side.
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 yes | yes | yes | no
3728 Arguments :
3729 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
3730
3731 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
3732 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003733 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3734 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003735
3736 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
3737
3738
3739clitcpka-idle <timeout>
3740 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
3741 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
3742 client side.
3743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3744 yes | yes | yes | no
3745 Arguments :
3746 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
3747 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
3748 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
3749 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
3750
3751 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
3752 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003753 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3754 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003755
3756 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
3757
3758
3759clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
3760 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
3761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3762 yes | yes | yes | no
3763 Arguments :
3764 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
3765 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
3766 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
3767 document.
3768
3769 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
3770 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02003771 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
3772 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003773
3774 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
3775
3776
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003777compression algo <algorithm> ...
3778compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003779compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003780 Enable HTTP compression.
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | yes | yes | yes
3783 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003784 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3785 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3786 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3787
3788 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003789 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3790 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3791 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003792
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003793 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003794 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003795
3796 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3797 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3798 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3799 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3800 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003801 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003802
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003803 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3804 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3805 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3806 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3807 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3808 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3809 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003810 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003811
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003812 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003813 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003814 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3815 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3816 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3817 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3818 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003819
3820 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3821 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3822 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3823 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3824 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003825 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3826 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3827 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3828 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3829 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003830 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3831 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003832
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003833 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003834 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3835 "Accept-Encoding" header
3836 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003837 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003838 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3839 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3840 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3841 "multipart"
3842 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3843 header
3844 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3845 and later
3846 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3847 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003848 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003849
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003850 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003851
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003852 Examples :
3853 compression algo gzip
3854 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003855
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003856
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003857cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003858 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3859 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003860 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003861 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | no | yes | yes
3864 Arguments :
3865 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3866 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3867 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3868 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3869 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3870 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003871 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003872 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3873 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3874
3875 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3876 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3877 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3878 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3879 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3880 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003881 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3882 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003883 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003884 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3885 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003886
3887 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003888 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003889
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003890 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003891 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003892 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003893 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003894 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3895 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3896 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3897 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3898 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3899 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3900 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003901
3902 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3903 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3904 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3905 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3906 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3907 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3908 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3909 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3910 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003911 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003912 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3913 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3914 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003916 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3917 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3918 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003919 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3920 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3921 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3922 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003923 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3924 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3925 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003926
3927 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3928 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3929 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3930 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3931 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3932 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3933 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3934 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3935 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3936
3937 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3938 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3939 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3940 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3941 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3942 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3943 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3944 persistence cookie in the cache.
3945 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3946
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003947 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3948 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3949 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3950 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3951 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003952 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003953 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3954 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3955 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3956 they logout.
3957
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003958 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3959 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3960 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3961 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3962
3963 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3964 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3965 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3966 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3967 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3968 this attribute.
3969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003970 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003971 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003972 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3973 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3974 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3975 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3976 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3977 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003978
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003979 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3980 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3981 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3982 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3983 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3984 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3985 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3986 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003987 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003988 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3989 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3990 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3991 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3992 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3993 the site.
3994
3995 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3996 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3997 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3998 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3999 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4000 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4001 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4002 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4003 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4004 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4005 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4006 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4007 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004008 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004009 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4010 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4011
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004012 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4013 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4014 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4015 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4016 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4017 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4018
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004019 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4020 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4021 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4022 repeated.
4023
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004024 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4025 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4026 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4027 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004028
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004029 Examples :
4030 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4031 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4032 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004033 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004034
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004035 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004036
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004037
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004038declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4039 Declares a capture slot.
4040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4041 no | yes | yes | no
4042 Arguments:
4043 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4044
4045 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4046 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4047 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4048 for use in the response.
4049
4050 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004051 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004052 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4053
4054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004055default-server [param*]
4056 Change default options for a server in a backend
4057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4058 yes | no | yes | yes
4059 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004060 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4061 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4062 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4063 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004064
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004065 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004066 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4067
4068 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004071default_backend <backend>
4072 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | yes | yes | no
4075 Arguments :
4076 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4077
4078 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4079 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4080 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4081 will catch all undetermined requests.
4082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004083 Example :
4084
4085 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4086 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4087 default_backend dynamic
4088
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004089 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004092description <string>
4093 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4095 no | yes | yes | yes
4096 Arguments : string
4097
4098 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4099 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4100 it describes.
4101 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4102
4103
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104disabled
4105 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4107 yes | yes | yes | yes
4108 Arguments : none
4109
4110 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4111 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4112 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4113 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4114 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4115 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4116 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4117
4118 See also : "enabled"
4119
4120
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004121dispatch <address>:<port>
4122 Set a default server address
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004125 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004126
4127 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4128 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4129 during start-up.
4130
4131 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4132 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4133 possible with normal servers.
4134
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004135 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004136 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4137 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4138 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4139 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4140
4141 See also : "server"
4142
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004143
4144dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4145 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4147 yes | no | yes | yes
4148 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4149
4150 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004151 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004152 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4153 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004154 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004155 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004156
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004157enabled
4158 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4160 yes | yes | yes | yes
4161 Arguments : none
4162
4163 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4164 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4165
4166 See also : "disabled"
4167
4168
4169errorfile <code> <file>
4170 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 yes | yes | yes | yes
4173 Arguments :
4174 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004175 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004176 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004177
4178 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004179 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004180 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004181 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4182 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004183
4184 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4185 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4186 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4187
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004188 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4189
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004190 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4191 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4192 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4193 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4194 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4195 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4196 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4197 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4198 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004199
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004200 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4201 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4202 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004203 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004204 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4205
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004206 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004207
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004208 Example :
4209 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004210 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004211 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4212 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4213
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004215errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4216 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4217 section.
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | yes | yes | yes
4220 Arguments :
4221 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4222
4223 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004224 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004225 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004226
4227 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4228 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4229 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4230 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4231 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004232 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004233 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4234
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004235 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4236 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004237
4238 Example :
4239 errorfiles generic
4240 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4241
4242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004243errorloc <code> <url>
4244errorloc302 <code> <url>
4245 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 yes | yes | yes | yes
4248 Arguments :
4249 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004250 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004251 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004252
4253 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4254 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4255 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4256 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004257 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004258
4259 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4260 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4261 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4262
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004263 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4264
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004265 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4266 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4267 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4268 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004269 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004270 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4271 request.
4272
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004273 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004274
4275
4276errorloc303 <code> <url>
4277 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4279 yes | yes | yes | yes
4280 Arguments :
4281 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004282 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004283 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004284
4285 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4286 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4287 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4288 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004289 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004290
4291 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4292 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4293 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4294
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004295 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004297 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4298 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4299 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4300 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004301 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004302
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004303 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004304
4305
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004306email-alert from <emailaddr>
4307 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004308 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4310 yes | yes | yes | yes
4311
4312 Arguments :
4313
4314 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4315
4316 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4317 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4318
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004319 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004320 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4321 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004322
4323
4324email-alert level <level>
4325 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4326 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 yes | yes | yes | yes
4329
4330 Arguments :
4331
4332 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4333 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4334 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4335
4336 By default level is alert
4337
4338 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4339 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4340 for the proxy.
4341
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004342 Alerts are sent when :
4343
4344 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4345 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4346 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4347 is notice or lower
4348 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4349 and a health check status update occurs
4350
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004351 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4352 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004353 section 3.6 about mailers.
4354
4355
4356email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4357 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4358 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | yes | yes | yes
4360
4361 Arguments :
4362
4363 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4364
4365 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4366 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4367
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004368 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4369 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004370
4371
4372email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4373 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4374 mailers.
4375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4376 yes | yes | yes | yes
4377
4378 Arguments :
4379
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004380 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004381
4382 By default the systems hostname is used.
4383
4384 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4385 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4386 for the proxy.
4387
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004388 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4389 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004390
4391
4392email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004393 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004394 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | yes | yes | yes
4397
4398 Arguments :
4399
4400 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4401
4402 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4403 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4404
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004405 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004406 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4407
4408
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004409force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4410 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004412 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004413
4414 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4415 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4416 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4417 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4418 marked down for maintenance operations.
4419
4420 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4421 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4422 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4423 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4424 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4425 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4426 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4427 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4428 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4429
4430 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4431 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4432 is used.
4433
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004434 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004435 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004436
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004437
4438filter <name> [param*]
4439 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4441 no | yes | yes | yes
4442 Arguments :
4443 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4444 referenced in section 9.
4445
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004446 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004447 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004448 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4449 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004450
4451 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4452 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4453
4454 Example:
4455 listen
4456 bind *:80
4457
4458 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4459 filter compression
4460 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4461
4462 compression algo gzip
4463 compression offload
4464
4465 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4466
4467 See also : section 9.
4468
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004469
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004470fullconn <conns>
4471 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4473 yes | no | yes | yes
4474 Arguments :
4475 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4476 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4477
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004478 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004479 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004480 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004481 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4482 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4483 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4484 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4485 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004486 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004487
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004488 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4489 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004490 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4491 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4492 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004494 Example :
4495 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4496 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4497 # connections.
4498 backend dynamic
4499 fullconn 10000
4500 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4501 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4502
4503 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4504
4505
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004506grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004507 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004509 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004510 Arguments :
4511 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4512 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4513 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4514
4515 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4516 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004517 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004518 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4519
4520 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4521 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4522 simplify it.
4523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004524
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004525hash-balance-factor <factor>
4526 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4528 yes | no | no | yes
4529 Arguments :
4530 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4531 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004532 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004533
4534 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4535 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4536 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4537 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4538 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4539 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4540 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4541
4542 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4543 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4544 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4545 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4546 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4547
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004548 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4549 consistent hashing mechanism.
4550
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004551 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4552
4553
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004554hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004555 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4557 yes | no | yes | yes
4558 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004559 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4560 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004561
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004562 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4563 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4564 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4565 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4566 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4567 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4568 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4569 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4570 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4571 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004572
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004573 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4574 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4575 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4576 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4577 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4578 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4579 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4580 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4581 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4582 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4583 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4584 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4585 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004586 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4587 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004588
4589 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004591 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004592 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4593 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4594 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004595 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4596 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4597 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004598
4599 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4600 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004601 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4602 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4603 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4604 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4605
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004606 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4607 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4608 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4609 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4610 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4611 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4612 parameter.
4613
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004614 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4615 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4616 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4617 used on strings.
4618
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004619 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4620
4621 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4622 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4623 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4624 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4625 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4626 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4627 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4628 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4629 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4630 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4631 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4632 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004633
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004634 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4635 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4636 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004637
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004638 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004639
4640
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004641http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4642 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4643 ones).
4644
4645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 no | yes | yes | yes
4647
4648 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4649 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4650 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4651 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4652 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4653 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4654
4655 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4656 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4657 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4658
4659 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4660 below.
4661
4662 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4663 instance.
4664
4665 Example:
4666 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4667 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4668 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4669
4670http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4671
4672 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4673 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4674 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4675 example, or to pass some internal information.
4676 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4677 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4678 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4679
4680http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4681
4682 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4683 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4684
4685http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4686
4687 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4688
4689http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4690 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4691
4692 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4693
4694 Example:
4695 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4696
4697 # applied to:
4698 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4699
4700 # outputs:
4701 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4702
4703 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4704
4705http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4706 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4707
4708 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4709
4710 Example:
4711 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4712
4713 # applied to:
4714 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4715
4716 # outputs:
4717 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4718
4719http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4720
4721 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4722 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4723 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4724
4725http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4727
4728 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4729 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4730 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4731 fallback.
4732
4733 Example:
4734 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4735 http-response set-status 431
4736 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4737 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4738
4739http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4740
4741 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4742 inline.
4743
4744 Arguments:
4745 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4746 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4747 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4748 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4749 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4750 (request and response)
4751 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4752 processing
4753 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4754 processing
4755 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4756 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4757 and '_'.
4758
4759 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4760 followed by some converters.
4761
4762 Example:
4763 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4764
4765http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4766
4767 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4768 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4769 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4770 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4771 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004772 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004773 processing.
4774
4775 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4776 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004777 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004778 rules evaluation.
4779
4780http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4781
4782 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4783 details about <var-name>.
4784
4785 Example:
4786 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4787
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004788
4789http-check comment <string>
4790 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4791 it fails.
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | no | yes | yes
4794
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004795 Arguments :
4796 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4797 rule fails.
4798
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004799 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4800 user-friendly error reporting.
4801
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004802 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004803 "http-check expect".
4804
4805
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004806http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4807 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004808 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004809 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | no | yes | yes
4812
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004813 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004814 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4815
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004816 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004817 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004818
4819 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4820 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4821 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4822 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4823
4824 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4825
4826 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4827
4828 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4829
4830 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4831
4832 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4833
4834 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4835 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4836 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4837 is used.
4838
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004839 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4840 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4841 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4842 haproxy -vv.
4843
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004844 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4845
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004846 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4847 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4848 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4849 different ports or with different servers.
4850
4851 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4852 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4853 the port with a "http-check connect".
4854
4855 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4856 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4857 do.
4858
4859 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4860 unset-var or comment rules.
4861
4862 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004863 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4864 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4865 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4866 option httpchk
4867
4868 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004869 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004870 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004871 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004872 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004873 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004874
4875 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4876
4877 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004878
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004879
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004880http-check disable-on-404
4881 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004883 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004884 Arguments : none
4885
4886 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4887 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4888 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4889 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4890 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4891 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4892 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4893 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004894 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4895 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4896 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004898 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004899
4900
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004901http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004902 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4903 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4904 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004905 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004907 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004908
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004909 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004910 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4911
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004912 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4913 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4914 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4915 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4916 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4917 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4918 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4919 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4920 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4921 result is always conclusive.
4922
4923 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4924 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4925 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004926 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4927 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4928 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4929 example 404 with disable-on-404
4930 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4931 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4932 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004933
4934 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4935 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004936 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4937 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4938 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4939 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4940 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4941 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004942
4943 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4944 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004945 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4946 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4947 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4948 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004949 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4950
4951 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4952 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4953 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4954 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4955
4956 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4957 informational message reported in logs if an error
4958 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4959 log-format string.
4960
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004961 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004962 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4963 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004964 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4965 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4966 details on the supported keywords.
4967
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004968 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4969 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4970 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4971 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004972
4973 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4974 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4975 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4976 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4977 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4978
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004979 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4980 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4981 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4982 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4983 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4984 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4985 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004986
4987 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004988 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004989 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4990 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4991 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4992 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4993
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004994 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4995 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004996 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4997 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4998 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4999 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5000 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5001 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5002 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5003 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005004 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5005 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5006 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5007 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5008 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5009 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5010 insensitive on the header names.
5011
5012 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5013 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5014 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5015 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5016 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5017 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005018
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005019 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005020 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005021 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5022 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5023 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5024 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5025 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005026 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005027 trace).
5028
5029 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005030 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005031 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5032 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5033 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5034 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5035 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005036 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005037
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005038 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5039 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5040 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5041 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5042 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5043 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5044
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005045 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
5046 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
5047 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5048 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5049 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5050 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5051 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5052 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5053
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005054 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5055 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5056 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5057 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5058 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005059
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005060 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5061 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5062
5063 Examples :
5064 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005065 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005066
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005067 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5068 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5069
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005070 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005071 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005072
5073 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005074 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005075
5076 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005077 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005078
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005079 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005080 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081
5082
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005083http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005084 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5085 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005086 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5087 health checks.
5088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5089 yes | no | yes | yes
5090 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005091 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5092
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005093 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5094 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5095 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5096 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5097 to invent non-standard ones.
5098
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005099 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5100 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5101 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5102 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5103
5104 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5105 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5106 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5107 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005108
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005109 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005110 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005111 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005112 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5113 to add it.
5114
5115 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5116 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5117 to the log-format rules.
5118
5119 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5120 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5121 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005122
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005123 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5124 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5125 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5126 request.
5127
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005128 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5129 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5130 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005131 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5132 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5133 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5134 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005135 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005136 "http-check expect" directive is defined independently of this directive, just
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005137 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
5138
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005139 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
5140 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005141 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
5142 so, it will be ignored.
5143
5144 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5145 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5146 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5147 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5148 configured request authority.
5149
5150 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5151 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005152
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005153 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005154
5155
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005156http-check send-state
5157 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5159 yes | no | yes | yes
5160 Arguments : none
5161
5162 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5163 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5164 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5165 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5166 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5167
5168 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5169 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5170 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5171 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5172 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005173 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5174 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5175 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5176
5177 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5178 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5179 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5180
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005181 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5182 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5183 checked in multiple backends.
5184
5185 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5186 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5187
5188 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5189 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5190 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5191 one fails.
5192
5193 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5194 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5195 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5196
5197 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5198 server's queue.
5199
5200 Example of a header received by the application server :
5201 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5202 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5203
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005204 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5205 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005206
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005207
5208http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005209 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005210 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5211 yes | no | yes | yes
5212
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005213 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005214 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5215 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5216 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5217 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5218 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5219 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5220 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5221 and '-'.
5222
5223 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5224
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005225 Examples :
5226 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005227
5228
5229http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005230 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 yes | no | yes | yes
5233
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005234 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005235 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5236 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5237 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5238 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5239 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5241 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5242 and '-'.
5243
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005244 Examples :
5245 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005247
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005248http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5249 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5250 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5251 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5252 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | yes | yes | yes
5255 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005256 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005257 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005258 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5259 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005260
5261 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5262 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5263 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5264 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5265
5266 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5267 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5268 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5269 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5270
5271 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5272 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5273 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5274 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5275 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5276 chroot is performed.
5277
5278 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5279 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5280 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5281 considered.
5282
5283 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5284 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5285 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5286 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5287 considered as a raw string.
5288
5289 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5290 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5291 "content-type".
5292
5293 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5294 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5295 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5296 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5297 evaluated as a log-format string.
5298
5299 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5300 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5301 argument to "content-type".
5302
5303 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5304 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5305 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5306 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5307
5308 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5309 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5310 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5311 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5312 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5313 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5314 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5315 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5316
5317 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5318 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5319 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5320
5321 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5322 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5323
5324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005325http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005326 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5327
5328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 no | yes | yes | yes
5330
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005331 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5332 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5333 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5334 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5335 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005337 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5338 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005340 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005342 Example:
5343 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5344 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5345 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005347 http-request allow if nagios
5348 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5349 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5350 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005352 Example:
5353 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5354 acl add path /addacl
5355 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005357 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005358
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005359 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5360 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005362 Example:
5363 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5364 acl setmap path /setmap
5365 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005367 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005369 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5370 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005372 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5373 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005375http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005377 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5378 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5379 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5380 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5381 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5382 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5383 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5384 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005386http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005387
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005388 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5389 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5390 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5391 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5392 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5393 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5394 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5395 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005397http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005399 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5400 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005401
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005403http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005405 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5406 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5407 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5408 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5409 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005410
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005411 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5412 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5413 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5414 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5415 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5416 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5417 instead.
5418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005419 Example:
5420 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5421 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005422
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005423http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005424
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005425 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005427http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5428 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005430 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5431 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5432 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5433 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5434 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5435 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5436 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5437 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5438 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005440 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5441 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5442 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005443 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5444
5445 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5446 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5447 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5448 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005450http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005452 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5453 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5454 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5455 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5456 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5457 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005458
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005459http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005461 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005463http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005465 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5466 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5467 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5468 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5469 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5470 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005471
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005472http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5473http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5474 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5475 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5476 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5477 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005478
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005479 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5480 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5481 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005482 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005483 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5484 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5485 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005486 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005487 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005488
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005489http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5490 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5491 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5492 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5493
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005494http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5495
5496 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5497 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5498 pointed by <resolvers>.
5499 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5500 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5501 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5502 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5503 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5504 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5505 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5506 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5507 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5508 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5509 to 0.0.0.0.
5510
5511 Example:
5512 resolvers mydns
5513 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5514 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5515 timeout retry 1s
5516 hold valid 10s
5517 hold nx 3s
5518 hold other 3s
5519 hold obsolete 0s
5520 accepted_payload_size 8192
5521
5522 frontend fe
5523 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5524 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5525 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5526
5527 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5528 # which mean DNS resolution error
5529 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5530
5531 default_backend be
5532
5533 backend b_503
5534 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5535 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5536 # 503 error page to end users
5537
5538 backend be
5539 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5540 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5541 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5542 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5543 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5544
5545 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5546 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5547
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005548http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5549
5550 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5551 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5552 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5553 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005554 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5555 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005556
5557 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5558
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005559http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005561 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5562 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5563 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5564 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5565 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005567http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005569 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5570 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5571 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5572 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005574http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005576
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005577 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005578 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5579 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5580 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5581 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5582 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005583
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005584 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5585 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5586 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5587 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5588 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005589
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005590 Example:
5591 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5592
5593 # applied to:
5594 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5595
5596 # outputs:
5597 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5598
5599 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005600
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005601 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5602
5603 # applied to:
5604 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005605
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005606 # outputs:
5607 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005608
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005609http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5610 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5611
5612 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5613 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005614 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5615 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5616 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005617
5618 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5619 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5620 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5621
5622 Example:
5623 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5624 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5625
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005626 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5627 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5628 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5629 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5630
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005631http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5632 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5633
5634 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5635 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5636 query-string are replaced.
5637
5638 Example:
5639 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5640 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5641
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005642http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5643 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5644
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005645 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5646 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5647 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5648 against.
5649
5650 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5651 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5652 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005653
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005654 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5655 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5656 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5657 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5658 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5659 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5660 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5661 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5662 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005663 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5664 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005665
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005666 Example:
5667 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5668 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005669
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005670 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5671 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005672
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005673http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5674 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005675
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005676 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5677 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5678 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5679 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005680
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005681 Example:
5682 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005683
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005684 # applied to:
5685 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005686
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005687 # outputs:
5688 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005689
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005690http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5691 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5692 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005693 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5695
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005696 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005697 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5698 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005699 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005700 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005701 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005702 are followed to create the response :
5703
5704 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5705 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5706 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5707 ignored.
5708
5709 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5710 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005711 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005712 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5713 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005714
5715 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5716 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5717 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005718 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005719 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005720
5721 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5722 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5723 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005724 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005725 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5726 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005727
5728 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5729 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5730 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5731 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5732 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5733 as a raw content.
5734
5735 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5736 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5737 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5738 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5739 considered as a raw string.
5740
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005741 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005742 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5743 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5744 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5745
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005746 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5747 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02005748 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005749
5750 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5751
5752 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005753 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005754 if { path /ping }
5755
5756 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5757 if { path /favicon.ico }
5758
5759 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5760 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5761 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005763http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5764http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5767 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5768 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005769
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005770http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5771 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005772
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005773 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5774 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5775 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5776 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005778http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005780 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5781 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5782 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5783 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5784 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005786 Arguments:
5787 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5788 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005790 Example:
5791 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5792 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5795 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005796
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005797http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005799 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5800 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5801 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 Arguments:
5804 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5805 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807 Example:
5808 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5809 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005811 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5812 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5813 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005814
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005815http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005816
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005817 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5818 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5819 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5820 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5821 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 Example:
5824 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5825 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5826 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5827 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5828 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5829 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5830 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5831 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5832 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005834http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005836 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5837 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5838 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5839 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5840 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005842http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5843 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005845 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5846 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5847 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5848 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5849 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5850 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5851 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5852 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5853 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005854
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005855http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005857 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5858 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5859 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5860 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5861 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5862 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5863 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005864
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005865http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005867 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5868 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5869 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005870
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005871http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005873 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5874 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5875 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5876 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5877 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5878 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5879 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5880 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005881
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005882http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005883
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005884 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5885 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5886 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5887 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5888 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5889 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 Example :
5892 # prepend the host name before the path
5893 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005894
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005895http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5896
5897 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
5898 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
5899 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
5900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5904 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5905 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5906 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5907 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5912 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5913 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5914 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5915 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5916 values have higher priority.
5917 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5918 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5919 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5920 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5921 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005922
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005923http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5926 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5927 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5928 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5929 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5930 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5931 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005932
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005933 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005934
5935 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005936 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5937 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005939http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5940 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5941 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5942 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005943 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5944 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945
5946 Arguments :
5947 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5948 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005949
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005950 See also "option forwardfor".
5951
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005952 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005953 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5954 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5955
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005956 # After the masking this will track connections
5957 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5958 http-request track-sc0 src
5959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5961 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5962
5963http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5964
5965 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5966 expression.
5967
5968 Arguments:
5969 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5970 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005971
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005972 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005973 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5974 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5975
5976 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5977 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5978 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5979
5980http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5981
5982 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5983 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5984 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5985 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5986 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5987 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5988 information from the request.
5989
5990 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5991
5992http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5993
5994 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5995 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5996 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5997 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5998 path and the query string.
5999 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6000
6001http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6002
6003 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6004 inline.
6005
6006 Arguments:
6007 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6008 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6009 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6010 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6011 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6012 (request and response)
6013 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6014 processing
6015 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6016 processing
6017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6018 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6019 and '_'.
6020
6021 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6022 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006023
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006024 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006025 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6028 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6031 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6032 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6033 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6034 agent name must be used.
6035
6036 Arguments:
6037 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6038
6039 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6040 configuration.
6041
6042http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6043
6044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6045 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6046 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6047 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6048 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6049 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6050 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6051 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6052 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6053 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6054 action.
6055 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6056 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6057 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6058 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6059 you fully understand how it works.
6060
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006061http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6062
6063 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6064 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6065 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6066 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6067 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006068 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006069 processing.
6070
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006071 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006072 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6073 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6074 rules evaluation.
6075
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006076http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6077http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6078 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6079 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6080 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6081 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082
6083 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6084 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6085 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006086 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6087 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6088 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6089 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6090 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6091 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6092 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6093 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6094 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6095 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006096 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006097 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6098 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6099 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6100 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6101 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102
6103http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6104http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6105http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6106
6107 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6108 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6109 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6110 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006111 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006112 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6113 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6114 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6115 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6116 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6117 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6118 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6119
6120 Arguments :
6121 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6122 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6123 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6124 select which table entry to update the counters.
6125
6126 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6127 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6128 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6129 that table until the session ends.
6130
6131 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6132 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6133 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6134 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6135 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6136 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6137 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6138 useful information.
6139
6140 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6141 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6142 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6143 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6144 checks that make use of it.
6145
6146http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6147
6148 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006149
6150 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006151 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006152
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006153http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6154
6155 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6156 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6157 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6158 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6159 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6160 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6161
6162 Arguments :
6163 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6164
6165 Example:
6166 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006168http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006170 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6171 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6172 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006173
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006175http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006176 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6177
6178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6179 no | yes | yes | yes
6180
6181 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6182 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6183 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6184 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6185 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6186 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006188 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6189 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006191 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006193 Example:
6194 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006196 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006198 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6199 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006200
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006201 Example:
6202 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006204 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006205
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006206 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6207 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006209 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6210 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006212http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006213
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006214 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6215 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6216 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6217 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6218 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6219 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6220 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6221 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006223http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006224
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006225 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6226 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6227 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6228 example, or to pass some internal information.
6229 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6230 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6231 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006232
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006233http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006234
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006235 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6236 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006237
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006238http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006239
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006240 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006242http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6245 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6246 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6247 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6248 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6249 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6250 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006252 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6253 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6254 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6255 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6256 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006257
6258 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6259 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6260 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6261 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006263http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006265 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6266 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6267 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6268 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6269 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6270 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006272http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006274 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006275
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006276http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006278 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6279 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6280 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6281 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6282 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6283 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006284
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006285http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6286http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6287 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6288 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6289 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6290 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006291
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006292 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6293 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6294 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006295 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006296 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6297 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6298 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006299 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006300 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006301
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006302http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006303
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006304 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6305 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6306 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6307 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6308 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6309 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006311http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006313
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006314 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6315 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006317 Example:
6318 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006319
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006320 # applied to:
6321 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006322
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006323 # outputs:
6324 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006325
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006326 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006328http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006330
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006331 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006332 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006334 Example:
6335 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006336
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006337 # applied to:
6338 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006340 # outputs:
6341 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006342
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006343http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6344 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6345 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006346 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006349 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006350 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6351 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006352 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006353 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006354 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006355 are followed to create the response :
6356
6357 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6358 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6359 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6360 ignored.
6361
6362 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6363 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006364 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006365 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6366 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006367
6368 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6369 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6370 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006371 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006372 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006373
6374 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6375 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6376 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006377 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006378 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6379 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006380
6381 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6382 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6383 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6384 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6385 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6386 as a raw content.
6387
6388 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6389 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6390 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6391 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6392 considered as a raw string.
6393
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006394 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6395 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6396 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6397 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6398
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006399 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6400 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006401 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006402
6403 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6404
6405 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006406 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006407 if { status eq 404 }
6408
6409 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6410 string "This is the end !" \
6411 if { status eq 500 }
6412
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006413http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6414http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006415
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006416 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6417 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6418 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006419
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006420http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6421 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006422
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006423 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6424 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6425 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6426 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006428http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006430 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6431 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6432 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6433 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6434 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006436 Arguments:
6437 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006438
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006439 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6440 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006441
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006442http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006443
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006444 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6445 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6446 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006447
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006448http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6449
6450 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6451 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6452 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6453 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6454 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6455
6456http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6457
6458 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6459 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6460 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6461 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6462 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6463 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6464 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6465 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6466 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6467
6468http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6469
6470 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6471 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6472 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6473 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6474 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6475 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6476 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6477
6478http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479
6480 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6481 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6482 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6483 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6484 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6485 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6486 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6487 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6488
6489http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6491
6492 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6493 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6494 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6495 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006496
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006497 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006498 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6499 http-response set-status 431
6500 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6501 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006502
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006503http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006504
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006505 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6506 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6507 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6508 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6509 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6510 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6511 based on some information from the request.
6512
6513 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6514
6515http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6516
6517 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6518 inline.
6519
6520 Arguments:
6521 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6522 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6523 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6524 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6525 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6526 (request and response)
6527 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6528 processing
6529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6530 processing
6531 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6532 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6533 and '_'.
6534
6535 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6536 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006537
6538 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006539 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006540
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006541http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006542
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006543 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6544 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6545 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6546 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6547 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6548 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6549 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6550 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6551 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6552 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6553 action.
6554 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6555 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6556 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6557 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6558 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006559
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006560http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6561
6562 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6563 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6564 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6565 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6566 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006567 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006568 processing.
6569
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006570 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006571 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006572 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006573 rules evaluation.
6574
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006575http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6576http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6577http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006578
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006579 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6580 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6581 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6582 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6583 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6584 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6585
6586http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6587
6588 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6589 about <var-name>.
6590
6591 Example:
6592 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6593
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006594
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006595http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6596 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6597
6598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 yes | no | yes | yes
6600
6601 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006602 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6603 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6604 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006605
6606 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6607
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006608 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6609 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6610 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6611 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6612 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6613 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6614 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6615 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6616 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6617 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006618
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006619 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6620 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6621 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6622 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6623 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6624 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6625 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006626 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6627 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6628 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6629 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6630 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6631 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006632
6633 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6634 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6635 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6636 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6637 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6638 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6639 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6640 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006641 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006642 downsides of rare connection failures.
6643
6644 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6645 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6646 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6647 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6648 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6649 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006650 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006651 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6652 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6653 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6654 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6655 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6656
6657 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006658 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6659 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6660 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006661
Amaury Denoyelle7239c242020-10-15 16:41:09 +02006662 - connections sent to a server with a variable value as TLS SNI extension
6663 are marked private and are never shared. This is not the case if the SNI
6664 is guaranteed to be a constant, as for example using a literal string;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006665
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006666 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6667 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006668
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006669 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006670
6671 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6672 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6673 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6674
6675 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6676
6677
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006678http-send-name-header [<header>]
6679 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006680 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6681 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006682 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006683 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6684
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006685 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6686 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6687 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6688 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6689 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6690 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6691 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6692 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6693 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6694 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6695 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6696 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6697 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6698 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6699 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6700 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006701
6702 See also : "server"
6703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006704id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006705 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 no | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments : none
6709
6710 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6711 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6712 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006713
6714
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006715ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6716 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6717 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006718 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006719
6720 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6721 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6722 and running).
6723
6724 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6725 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6726 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006727 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006728 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6729
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006730 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6731 "unless" condition is met.
6732
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006733 Example:
6734 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6735 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6736 ignore-persist if url_static
6737
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006738 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6739
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006740load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6741 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6743 yes | no | yes | yes
6744
6745 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6746 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6747 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006748 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006749 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6750 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6751 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6752 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6753
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006754 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006755 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006756 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006757
6758 Arguments:
6759 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6760 named "server-state-file".
6761
6762 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6763 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6764 name is used as a file name.
6765
6766 none don't load any stat for this backend
6767
6768 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006769 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6770 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6771 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006772 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006773 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006774
6775 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6776 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6777
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006778 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006779
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006780 global
6781 stats socket /tmp/socket
6782 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006783
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006784 defaults
6785 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006786
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006787 backend bk
6788 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6789 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006790
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006791
6792 Then one can run :
6793
6794 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6795
6796 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6797
6798 1
6799 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6800 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6801 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6802
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006803 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006804
6805 global
6806 stats socket /tmp/socket
6807 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6808
6809 defaults
6810 load-server-state-from-file local
6811
6812 backend bk
6813 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6814 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6815
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006816
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006817 Then one can run :
6818
6819 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6820
6821 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6822
6823 1
6824 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6825 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6826 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6827
6828 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6829 "show servers state"
6830
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006832log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006833log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6834 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006835no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006836 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6838 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006839
6840 Prefix :
6841 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6842 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6843 prefix does not allow arguments.
6844
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006845 Arguments :
6846 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6847 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6848 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6849 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6850 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6851 parameter.
6852
6853 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6854 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6855
6856 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6857 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6858 standard syslog port).
6859
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006860 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6861 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6862 standard syslog port).
6863
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006864 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6865 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6866 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006867 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006868
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006869 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6870 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6871 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6872 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6873 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6874 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6875 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6876 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6877 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6878 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6879 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6880 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6881 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6882 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6883 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6884 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006885 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6886 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006887
6888 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6889 and "fd@2", see above.
6890
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006891 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6892 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6893 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6894 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6895 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6896 having the logs instantly available.
6897
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006898 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6899 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006900
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006901 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6902 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6903 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6904 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6905 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6906 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6907 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6908 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6909 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6910 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006911 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006912
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006913 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6914 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6915 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6916 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6917 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6918
6919 <sample_size>
6920 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6921 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6922 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6923 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6924 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6925
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006926 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6927 one of the following :
6928
6929 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6930 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6931
6932 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6933 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6934
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006935 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
6936 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
6937 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6938 designed to be used with a local log server.
6939
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006940 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6941 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6942 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6943 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6944 systemd logger consumes.
6945
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02006946 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6947 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
6948 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
6949 used with a local log server.
6950
6951 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
6952 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
6953 designed to be used with a local log server.
6954
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006955 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6956 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6957 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6958 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6959
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006960 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006962 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6963 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6964 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6965
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006966 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6967 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6968 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6969 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006970
6971 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6972 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6973 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006974 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6975 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6976 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6977 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6978 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006979
6980 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6981
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006982 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6983 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6984 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006985
6986 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6987 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6988 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6989 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6990
6991 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6992 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006993
6994 Example :
6995 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006996 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6997 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6998 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006999 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7000 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007001 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007002
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007003
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007004log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007005 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007008
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007009 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7010 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7011 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7012 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7013 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007014
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007015 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7016 "option httplog" directives.
7017
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007018log-format-sd <string>
7019 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7020 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7021 yes | yes | yes | no
7022
7023 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7024 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7025 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7026 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7027 which covers the log format string in depth.
7028
7029 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7030 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7031
7032 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7033 log format to "rfc5424".
7034
7035 Example :
7036 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7037
7038
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007039log-tag <string>
7040 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7042 yes | yes | yes | yes
7043
7044 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7045 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7046 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7047 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7048 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7049 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7050 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7051 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7052 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007053
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007054max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7055 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7057 yes | no | yes | yes
7058
7059 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7060 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7061 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7062 servers.
7063
7064 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7065 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7066 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7067 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7068 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007069 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007070 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7071 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7072 picking a different server.
7073
7074 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7075 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7076 even if they have to be queued.
7077
7078 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7079 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7080
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007081max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7082 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7083 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7084 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007085
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007086maxconn <conns>
7087 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 yes | yes | yes | no
7090 Arguments :
7091 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7092 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7093 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7094 closes.
7095
7096 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7097 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7098 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7099 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007100 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7101 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7102 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7103 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007104
7105 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7106 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7107 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7108
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007109 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7110 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007111
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007112 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7113
7114
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007115mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007116 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7118 yes | yes | yes | yes
7119 Arguments :
7120 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7121 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7122 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7123 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7124
7125 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7126 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7127 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7128 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7129 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7130
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007131 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7132 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7133 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007134
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007135 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007136 defaults http_instances
7137 mode http
7138
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007139
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007140monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007141 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7143 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007144 Arguments :
7145 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7146 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007147 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007148 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7149 backend and its backup.
7150
7151 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7152 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7153 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7154 servers in a list of backends.
7155
7156 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7157 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7158 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7159 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7160 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7161 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7162 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007163 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7164 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007165
7166 Example:
7167 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007168 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007169 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7170 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7171 monitor-uri /site_alive
7172 monitor fail if site_dead
7173
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007174 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007175
7176
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007177monitor-uri <uri>
7178 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7180 yes | yes | yes | no
7181 Arguments :
7182 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7183 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7184
7185 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7186 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7187 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7188 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7189 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7190 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7191 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7192 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7193
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007194 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007195 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7196 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7197 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7198 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7199 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7200 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007201
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007202 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7203 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7204 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7205 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7206
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007207 Example :
7208 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7209 frontend www
7210 mode http
7211 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7212
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007213 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007215
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007216option abortonclose
7217no option abortonclose
7218 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7220 yes | no | yes | yes
7221 Arguments : none
7222
7223 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7224 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7225 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7226 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007227 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007228 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7229 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7230 encountered while delivering the response.
7231
7232 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7233 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7234 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7235 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7236 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7237 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007238 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007239 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007240 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007241 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7242 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7243 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7244
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007245 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7246 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007247 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7248 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7249 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7250 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7251 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7252 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007253 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007254
7255 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7256 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7257
7258 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7259
7260
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007261option accept-invalid-http-request
7262no option accept-invalid-http-request
7263 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7265 yes | yes | yes | no
7266 Arguments : none
7267
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007268 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007269 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007270 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007271 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7272 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7273 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7274 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7275 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007276 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7277 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7278 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7279 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007280 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007281 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007282 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7283 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7284 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007285
7286 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7287 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7288 been confirmed.
7289
7290 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7291 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007292 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7293 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007294 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7295
7296 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7297 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7298
7299 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7300 stats socket.
7301
7302
7303option accept-invalid-http-response
7304no option accept-invalid-http-response
7305 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7307 yes | no | yes | yes
7308 Arguments : none
7309
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007310 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007311 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007312 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007313 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7314 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7315 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7316 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7317 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007318 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7319 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7320 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007321
7322 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7323 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7324 been confirmed.
7325
7326 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7327 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7328 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7329 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7330
7331 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7332 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7333
7334 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7335 stats socket.
7336
7337
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007338option allbackups
7339no option allbackups
7340 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7342 yes | no | yes | yes
7343 Arguments : none
7344
7345 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7346 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7347 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7348 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7349 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7350 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7351 order between the backup servers anymore.
7352
7353 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7354 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7355
7356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7358
7359
7360option checkcache
7361no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007362 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 yes | no | yes | yes
7365 Arguments : none
7366
7367 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7368 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007369 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007370 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7371 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007372 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007373
7374 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007375 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007376 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007377 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7378 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007379 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007380 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007381 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7382 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007383 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007384 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7385 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007386 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007387 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7388 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7389 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7390 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7391 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7392 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7393 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7394 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7395 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7396
7397 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007398 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7399 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7400 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7401 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007402
7403 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7404 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007405 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007406 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007407
7408 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7409 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7410
7411
7412option clitcpka
7413no option clitcpka
7414 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 yes | yes | yes | no
7417 Arguments : none
7418
7419 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7420 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007422 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7423
7424 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7425 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7426 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7427 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7428
7429 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7430 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7431 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7432 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7433 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7434
7435 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7436
7437 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7438 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7439 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7440
7441 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7442 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7443
7444 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7445
7446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007447option contstats
7448 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7450 yes | yes | yes | no
7451 Arguments : none
7452
7453 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7454 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7455 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7456 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007457 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7458 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7459 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7460 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7461 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007462
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007463option disable-h2-upgrade
7464no option disable-h2-upgrade
7465 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7466 connection.
7467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7468 yes | yes | yes | no
7469 Arguments : none
7470
7471 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7472 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7473 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7474 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7475 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7476 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7477 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7478 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7479
7480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007482
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007483option dontlog-normal
7484no option dontlog-normal
7485 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7487 yes | yes | yes | no
7488 Arguments : none
7489
7490 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7491 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7492 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7493 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7494 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7495 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7496 logged.
7497
7498 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7499 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7500 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7501
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007502 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007503 logging.
7504
7505
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007506option dontlognull
7507no option dontlognull
7508 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 yes | yes | yes | no
7511 Arguments : none
7512
7513 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7514 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7515 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7516 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7517 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7518 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007519 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7520 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7521 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007522
7523 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007524 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007525 would not be logged.
7526
7527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7529
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007530 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007531 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007532
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007533
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007534option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007535 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7537 yes | yes | yes | yes
7538 Arguments :
7539 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7540 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007541 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007542 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007543
7544 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7545 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7546 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7547 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7548 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7549 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7550 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007551 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7552 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7553 possible that the client has already brought one.
7554
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007555 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007556 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007557 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007558 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007559 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007560 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007561
7562 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7563 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7564 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7565 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7566 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7567 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7568 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7569
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007570 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7571 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7572 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7573 are under the control of the end-user.
7574
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007575 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007576 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7577 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007578 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7579 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7580 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007581
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007582 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007583 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7584 frontend www
7585 mode http
7586 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7587
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007588 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7589 backend www
7590 mode http
7591 option forwardfor header X-Client
7592
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007593 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007594 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007595
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007596
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007597option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7598no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7599 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 yes | yes | yes | no
7602 Arguments : none
7603
7604 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7605 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7606 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7607 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7608 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7609 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7610 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7611
7612 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7613 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7614 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7615 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7616 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7617 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7618 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7619 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7620 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7621 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7622
7623 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7624
7625 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7626 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7627
7628 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7629 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7630
7631
7632option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7633no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7634 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7636 yes | no | yes | yes
7637 Arguments : none
7638
7639 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7640 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7641 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7642 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7643 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7644 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7645 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7646
7647 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7648 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7649 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7650 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7651 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7652 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7653 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7654 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7655 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7656 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7657
7658 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7659
7660 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7661 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7662
7663 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7664 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7665
7666
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007667option http-buffer-request
7668no option http-buffer-request
7669 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7671 yes | yes | yes | yes
7672 Arguments : none
7673
7674 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7675 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7676 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7677 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7678 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7679 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007680 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7681 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7682 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7683 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007684
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007685 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007686
7687
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007688option http-ignore-probes
7689no option http-ignore-probes
7690 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 yes | yes | yes | no
7693 Arguments : none
7694
7695 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7696 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7697 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7698 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7699 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7700 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7701 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7702 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7703 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007704 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7705 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007706 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7707
7708 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7709 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7710 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7711 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7712 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7713 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7714 are often the only way to detect them.
7715
7716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7718
7719 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7720
7721
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007722option http-keep-alive
7723no option http-keep-alive
7724 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7726 yes | yes | yes | yes
7727 Arguments : none
7728
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007729 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7730 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007731 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7732 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007733 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7734 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7735 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007736
7737 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7738 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007739 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7740 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7741 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7742 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7743 situations where this option may be useful :
7744
7745 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007746 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007747
7748 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7749 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7750
7751 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7752 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7753 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7754 request.
7755
7756 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7757 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007758 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7759 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7760 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007761
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007762 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7763 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7764 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7765 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7766 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7767 not set.
7768
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007769 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7770 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7771 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007772
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007773 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007774 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007775 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007776
7777
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007778option http-no-delay
7779no option http-no-delay
7780 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7782 yes | yes | yes | yes
7783 Arguments : none
7784
7785 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7786 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7787 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7788 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7789 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7790 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7791 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7792 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7793 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7794 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7795 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7796 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7797 affected.
7798
7799 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7800 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7801 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7802 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7803 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7804 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7805 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7806 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7807 latency environments.
7808
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007809 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7810
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007811
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007812option http-pretend-keepalive
7813no option http-pretend-keepalive
7814 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007816 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007817 Arguments : none
7818
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007819 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007820 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7821 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7822 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7823 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7824 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7825 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7826 consider the response complete.
7827
7828 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7829 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7830 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7831 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007832 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007833 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7834
7835 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7836 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7837 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7838 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7839 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7840 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7841 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7842
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007843 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7844 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7845 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7846 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7847 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7848 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007849
7850 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7851 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7852
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007853 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007854 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007855
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007856
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007857option http-server-close
7858no option http-server-close
7859 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7861 yes | yes | yes | yes
7862 Arguments : none
7863
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007864 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7865 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7866 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7867 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007868 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7869 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7870 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7871 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7872 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7873 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7874 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7875 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7876 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7877 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7878 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007879
7880 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7881 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7882 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7883 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007884 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7885 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007886
7887 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7888 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007889 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7890 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7891 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007892
7893 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7894 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7895
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007896 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7897 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007898
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007899option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007900no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007901 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | yes | yes | no
7904 Arguments : none
7905
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007906 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007907 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7908 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7909 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7910 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7911 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7912 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7913
7914 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7915 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007916 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7917 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7918 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007919
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007920 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7921 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7922 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7923 front of an existing proxy.
7924
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007925 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7926
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007927 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007928
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007929option httpchk
7930option httpchk <uri>
7931option httpchk <method> <uri>
7932option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007933 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7935 yes | no | yes | yes
7936 Arguments :
7937 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7938 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7939 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7940 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7941 ones.
7942
7943 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7944 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7945 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7946
7947 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7948 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7949 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007950 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007951
7952 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7953 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7954 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7955 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7956 the lack of any response.
7957
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007958 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7959 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7960 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7961 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7962
7963 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7964 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7965 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007966
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007967 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7968 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007969 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007970 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007971 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007972
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007973 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7974 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7975 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7976 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7977
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007978 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007979 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7980 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7981 backend https_relay
7982 mode tcp
7983 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7984 http-check send hdr Host www
7985 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007986
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007987 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7988 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7989 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007990
7991
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007992option httpclose
7993no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007994 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7996 yes | yes | yes | yes
7997 Arguments : none
7998
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007999 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8000 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8001 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8002 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008003 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008004
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008005 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8006 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008007 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008008 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8009 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008010
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008011 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8012 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8013 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008014
8015 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8016 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008017 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8018 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8019 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008020
8021 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8022 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8023
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008024 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008025
8026
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008027option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008028 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008030 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008031 Arguments :
8032 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8033 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8034 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008035 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008036 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008037
8038 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8039 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8040 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8041 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8042 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8043 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8044 ports.
8045
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008046 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8047 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008048
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008049 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008051 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008052
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008053
8054option http_proxy
8055no option http_proxy
8056 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8058 yes | yes | yes | yes
8059 Arguments : none
8060
8061 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8062 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8063 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8064 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8065 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8066
8067 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8068 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008069 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8070 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008071
8072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8074
8075 Example :
8076 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8077 backend direct_forward
8078 option httpclose
8079 option http_proxy
8080
8081 See also : "option httpclose"
8082
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008083
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008084option independent-streams
8085no option independent-streams
8086 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8088 yes | yes | yes | yes
8089 Arguments : none
8090
8091 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8092 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8093 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8094 receive data or not.
8095
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008096 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008097 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8098 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8099 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8100 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8101 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8102 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8103 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8104 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8105 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8106 socket buffers.
8107
8108 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8109 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8110 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8111 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8112 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8113
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008114 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008115
8116
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008117option ldap-check
8118 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
8121 Arguments : none
8122
8123 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8124 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8125 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8126 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8127
8128 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8129 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8130
8131 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8132 configure it.
8133
8134 Example :
8135 option ldap-check
8136
8137 See also : "option httpchk"
8138
8139
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008140option external-check
8141 Use external processes for server health checks
8142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8143 yes | no | yes | yes
8144
8145 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8146 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8147 command".
8148
8149 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8150
8151 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8152
8153
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008154option log-health-checks
8155no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008156 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8158 yes | no | yes | yes
8159 Arguments : none
8160
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008161 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8162 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8163 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008164
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008165 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8166 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8167 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8168 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8169 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8170
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008171 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008172 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008173
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008174 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8175 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8176 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008177
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008178
8179option log-separate-errors
8180no option log-separate-errors
8181 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8183 yes | yes | yes | no
8184 Arguments : none
8185
8186 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8187 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8188 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8189 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8190 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8191 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8192 provides very important information.
8193
8194 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8195 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8196 error logs.
8197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008198 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008199 logging.
8200
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008201
8202option logasap
8203no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008204 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8206 yes | yes | yes | no
8207 Arguments : none
8208
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008209 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8210 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8211 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8212 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8213
8214 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8215 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8216 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8217 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8218 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008219 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008220 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8221 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8222 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8223 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008224 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008225
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008226 Examples :
8227 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8228 mode http
8229 option httplog
8230 option logasap
8231 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8232
8233 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8234 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8235 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8236 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8237
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008238 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008239 logging.
8240
8241
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008242option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008243 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8245 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008246 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008247 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8248 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008249 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8250 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008251
8252 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8253 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008255 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8256 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8257 in the MySQL table, like this :
8258
8259 USE mysql;
8260 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8261 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8262
8263 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008264 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008265 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8266 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8267 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8268 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8269 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8270 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8271 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8272
8273 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8274 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008275
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008276 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008277
8278 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8279 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8280 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8281 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008282 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8283 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008284
8285 See also: "option httpchk"
8286
8287
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008288option nolinger
8289no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008290 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008293 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008295 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008296 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8297 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8298 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8299 connections.
8300
8301 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8302 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008303 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8304 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8305 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8306 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8307 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8308 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8309 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8310 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8311 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8312 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8313 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8314 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8315 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008316
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008317 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8318 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8319 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8320 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8321 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008322
8323 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8324 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008325 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
8326 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidently
8327 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008328
8329 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8330 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8331
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008332 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8333 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008334
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008335option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8336 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8338 yes | yes | yes | yes
8339 Arguments :
8340 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8341 matching <network>
8342 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8343 header name.
8344
8345 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8346 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8347 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8348 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8349 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8350 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8351 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8352 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8353 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8354 possible that the client has already brought one.
8355
8356 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8357 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8358 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8359 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8360 header and requires different one.
8361
8362 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8363 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8364 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8365 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8366 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8367 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8368 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8369
8370 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8371 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8372 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8373 both are defined.
8374
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008375 Examples :
8376 # Original Destination address
8377 frontend www
8378 mode http
8379 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8380
8381 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8382 backend www
8383 mode http
8384 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8385
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008386 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008387
8388
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008389option persist
8390no option persist
8391 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8392 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8393 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008394 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008395
8396 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8397 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8398 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8399 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8400 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8401 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8402 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8403 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8404 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8405 redirected to another valid server.
8406
8407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8409
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008410 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008411
8412
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008413option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8414 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 yes | no | yes | yes
8417 Arguments :
8418 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8419 PostgreSQL server.
8420
8421 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8422 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8423 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8424 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8425
8426 See also: "option httpchk"
8427
8428
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008429option prefer-last-server
8430no option prefer-last-server
8431 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | no | yes | yes
8434 Arguments : none
8435
8436 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8437 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8438 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8439 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8440 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8441 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8442 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8443 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8444 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008445 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8446 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008447 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8448 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8449 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008450 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8451 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8452 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008453
8454 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8455 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8456
8457 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8458
8459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008460option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008461option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008462no option redispatch
8463 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008466 Arguments :
8467 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8468 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8469 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008470 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008471 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008472 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008473 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8474 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8475 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008477
8478 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8479 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8480 be able to access the service anymore.
8481
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008482 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8483 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008484
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008485 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8486 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8487 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8488 following order:
8489
8490 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8491
8492 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8493 list, or
8494
8495 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8496
8497 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8498 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8499
8500 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8501 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8502 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8503 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8504
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008505 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008506 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8507 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008508
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008509 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8510 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8511
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008512 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008513
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008514
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008515option redis-check
8516 Use redis health checks for server testing
8517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8518 yes | no | yes | yes
8519 Arguments : none
8520
8521 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8522 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8523 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8524 find the "+PONG" response message.
8525
8526 Example :
8527 option redis-check
8528
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008529 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008530
8531
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008532option smtpchk
8533option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8534 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008537 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008538 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008539 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008540 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8541
8542 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8543 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8544 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8545
8546 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8547 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8548 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8549 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8550 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8551 dead server.
8552
8553 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8554 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008555 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008556 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8557
8558 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8559 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8560 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8561 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008562 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008563
8564 Example :
8565 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8566
8567 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8568
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008570option socket-stats
8571no option socket-stats
8572
8573 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8575 yes | yes | yes | no
8576
8577 Arguments : none
8578
8579
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008580option splice-auto
8581no option splice-auto
8582 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8584 yes | yes | yes | yes
8585 Arguments : none
8586
8587 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8588 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008589 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008590 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008591 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008592 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8593 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8594 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8595 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8596
8597 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8598 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8599 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8600 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8601 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8602 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8603 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8604 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8605 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8606 keyword.
8607
8608 Example :
8609 option splice-auto
8610
8611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8613
8614 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8615 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8616
8617
8618option splice-request
8619no option splice-request
8620 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8622 yes | yes | yes | yes
8623 Arguments : none
8624
8625 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008626 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008627 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8628 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8629 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8630 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8631
8632 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8633
8634 Example :
8635 option splice-request
8636
8637 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8638 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8639
8640 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8641 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8642
8643
8644option splice-response
8645no option splice-response
8646 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8648 yes | yes | yes | yes
8649 Arguments : none
8650
8651 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008652 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008653 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8654 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8655 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8656 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8657
8658 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8659
8660 Example :
8661 option splice-response
8662
8663 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8664 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8665
8666 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8667 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8668
8669
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008670option spop-check
8671 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 no | no | no | yes
8674 Arguments : none
8675
8676 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8677 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8678 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8679 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8680
8681 Example :
8682 option spop-check
8683
8684 See also : "option httpchk"
8685
8686
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008687option srvtcpka
8688no option srvtcpka
8689 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8691 yes | no | yes | yes
8692 Arguments : none
8693
8694 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8695 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008696 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008697 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8698
8699 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8700 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8701 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8702 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8703
8704 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8705 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8706 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8707 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8708 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8709
8710 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8711
8712 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8713 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8714 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8715
8716 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8717 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8718
8719 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8720
8721
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008722option ssl-hello-chk
8723 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8725 yes | no | yes | yes
8726 Arguments : none
8727
8728 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8729 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8730 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8731 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8732 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8733 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8734 hello message.
8735
8736 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8737 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8738 messages, which is appreciable.
8739
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008740 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8741 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8742 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008743
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008744 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8745
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008746
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008747option tcp-check
8748 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8749 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 yes | no | yes | yes
8751
8752 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8753 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8754
8755 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8756 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8757 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8758
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008759 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008760 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8761 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8762 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8763 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8764 only.
8765
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008766 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008767 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8768 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8769 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8770 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8771
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008772 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008773 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8774 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008775 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008776 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8777 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8778 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8779 the respective protocols.
8780 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008781 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008782
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008783 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008784
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008785 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8786 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8787 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8788 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008789
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008790 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8791 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8792 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008793
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008794
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008795 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008797 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008798 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008799
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008800 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008801 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008802 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008803
8804 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8805 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008806 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008807 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008808 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008809 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008810 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008811 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008812 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8813 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008814 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008815 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8816 tcp-check expect string +OK
8817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008818 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008819 (send many headers before analyzing)
8820 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008821 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008822 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8823 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8824 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8825 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008826 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008827
8828
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008829 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008830
8831
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008832option tcp-smart-accept
8833no option tcp-smart-accept
8834 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8836 yes | yes | yes | no
8837 Arguments : none
8838
8839 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8840 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8841 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8842 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8843 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8844 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8845
8846 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8847 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8848 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8849 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8850
8851 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8852 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8853 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008855
8856 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8857 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8858 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8859
8860 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8861 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8862 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8863
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008864 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8865
8866
8867option tcp-smart-connect
8868no option tcp-smart-connect
8869 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | no | yes | yes
8872 Arguments : none
8873
8874 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8875 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8876 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8877 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8878 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8879
8880 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8881 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8882 complex.
8883
8884 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8885 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8886 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8887
8888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8890
8891 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8892
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008893
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008894option tcpka
8895 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 yes | yes | yes | yes
8898 Arguments : none
8899
8900 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8901 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008902 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008903 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8904
8905 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8906 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8907 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8908 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8909
8910 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8911 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8912 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8913 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8914 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8915
8916 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8917
8918 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8919 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8920 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8921 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8922 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8923 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8924 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8925 backends.
8926
8927 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8928
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008929
8930option tcplog
8931 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008933 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008934 Arguments : none
8935
8936 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8937 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8938 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8939 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8940 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8941 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8942 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8943 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8944
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008945 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008947 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008948
8949
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008950option transparent
8951no option transparent
8952 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008954 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008955 Arguments : none
8956
8957 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8958 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8959 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8960 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8961 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8962 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8963 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8964 appropriate server.
8965
8966 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8967 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8968
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008969 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008970 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008971
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008972
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008973external-check command <command>
8974 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8976 yes | no | yes | yes
8977
8978 Arguments :
8979 <command> is the external command to run
8980
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008981 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8982
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008983 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008984
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008985 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8986 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8987 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8988 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8989 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8990 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008991
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008992 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8993
8994 Environment variables :
8995 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8996 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8997
8998 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8999
9000 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9001
9002 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9003 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9004 for a UNIX socket).
9005
9006 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9007
9008 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9009
9010 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9011
9012 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9013
9014 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9015
9016 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9017 socket).
9018
9019 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9020 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9021
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009022 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9023
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009024 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9025 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9026 failed.
9027
9028 Example :
9029 external-check command /bin/true
9030
9031 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9032
9033
9034external-check path <path>
9035 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9037 yes | no | yes | yes
9038
9039 Arguments :
9040 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9041
9042 The default path is "".
9043
9044 Example :
9045 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9046
9047 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9048 "external-check command"
9049
9050
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009051persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009052persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009053 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9055 yes | no | yes | yes
9056 Arguments :
9057 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009058 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9059 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009060
9061 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9062 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009064 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9065 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9066 forwarded to this server.
9067
9068 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9069 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9070 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009071 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009072 a single "listen" section.
9073
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009074 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9075 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9076 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9077
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009078 Example :
9079 listen tse-farm
9080 bind :3389
9081 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9082 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9083 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9084 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9085 persist rdp-cookie
9086 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009087 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009088 balance rdp-cookie
9089 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9090 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9091
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009092 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9093 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009094
9095
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009096rate-limit sessions <rate>
9097 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9099 yes | yes | yes | no
9100 Arguments :
9101 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9102 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9103
9104 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9105 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9106 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9107 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9108 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9109 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9110
9111 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9112 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9113 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9114 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9115
9116 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9117 listen smtp
9118 mode tcp
9119 bind :25
9120 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009121 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009122
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009123 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9124 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9125 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009126
9127 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9128
9129
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009130redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9131redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9132redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009133 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 no | yes | yes | yes
9136
9137 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009138 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009139
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009140 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009141 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009142 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9143 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9144 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009145
9146 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9147 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9148 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9149 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9150 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009151 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9152 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9153 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9154 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009155
9156 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9157 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9158 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9159 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9160 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9161 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009162 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009163 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009164 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9165 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9166 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009167
9168 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009169 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9170 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9171 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009172 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009173 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9174 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9175 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9176 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009177
9178 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009179 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009180
9181 - "drop-query"
9182 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9183 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9184 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9185 with a location-type redirect.
9186
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009187 - "append-slash"
9188 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9189 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9190 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9191 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9192
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009193 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9194 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9195 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9196 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9197 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9198 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9199 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9200
9201 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9202 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9203 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9204 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9205 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9206 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9207 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009208
9209 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9210 acl clear dst_port 80
9211 acl secure dst_port 8080
9212 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009213 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009214 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009215 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9216
9217 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009218 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9219 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9220 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009221 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009222
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009223 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9224 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9225 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9226
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009227 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009228 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009229
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009230 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009231 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9232 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9233 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009235 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009237
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009238retries <value>
9239 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 yes | no | yes | yes
9242 Arguments :
9243 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9244 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9245 default value is 3.
9246
9247 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9248 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9249 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9250
9251 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009252 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9253 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009254
9255 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9256 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9257
9258 See also : "option redispatch"
9259
9260
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009261retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009262 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9263 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9264 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009265 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9266 yes | no | yes | yes
9267 Arguments :
9268 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9269 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9270 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9271 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9272
9273 none never retry
9274
9275 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9276 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9277
9278 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9279 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9280 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9281 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9282 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9283 processing the request.
9284
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009285 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9286 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9287 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9288 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9289 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9290 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9291 overflow attack for example).
9292
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009293 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9294 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9295 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9296 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9297 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9298 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9299 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9300 amplify denial of service attacks.
9301
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009302 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9303 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9304 considered to be safe to retry.
9305
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009306 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9307 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9308 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9309 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9310
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009311 all-retryable-errors
9312 retry request for any error that are considered
9313 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9314 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9315 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9316
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009317 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9318 not cumulative.
9319
9320 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9321 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9322 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9323 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9324
9325 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9326 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9327 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9328 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9329 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9330 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9331 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9332 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9333 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9334 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9335 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9336 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9337
9338 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9339 should not use this directive.
9340
9341 The default is "conn-failure".
9342
9343 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9344
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009345server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009346 Declare a server in a backend
9347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9348 no | no | yes | yes
9349 Arguments :
9350 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009351 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009352 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009353
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009354 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9355 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9356 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9357 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009358 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9359 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9360 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9361 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9362 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009363 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9364 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9365 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9366 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9367 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9368 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9369 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009370 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009371 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9372 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9373 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9374 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9375 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9376 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009377 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9378 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009379 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9380 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009381
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009382 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009383 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9384 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9385 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9386 adding this value to the client's port.
9387
9388 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9389 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009390 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009391
9392 Examples :
9393 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9394 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009395 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009396 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9397 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9398 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009399
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009400 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9401 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9402 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9403 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9404 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9405
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009406 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9407 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009408
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009409server-state-file-name [<file>]
9410 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9411 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9412 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9413 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9414 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9415 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9416
9417 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9418 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9419
9420 global
9421 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9422
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009423 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009424 load-server-state-from-file
9425
9426 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9427 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009428
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009429server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9430 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9431 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9433 no | no | yes | yes
9434
9435 Arguments:
9436 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9437
9438 <num | range>
9439 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9440 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9441 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9442 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9443
9444 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9445
9446 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9447
9448 <params*>
9449 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9450 keyword.
9451
9452 Examples:
9453 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9454 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9455 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9456
9457 # or
9458 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9459
9460 # would be equivalent to:
9461 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9462 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9463 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9464
9465
9466
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009467source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009468source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009469source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009470 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9472 yes | no | yes | yes
9473 Arguments :
9474 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9475 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009476
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009477 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009478 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9479 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9480 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9481 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9482 supported prefixes are :
9483 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9484 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9485 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009486 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009487 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9488 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009489
9490 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9491 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009492 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9493 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9494 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009495
9496 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9497 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9498 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9499 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9500 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9501 <addr>.
9502
9503 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9504 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9505 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9506 port.
9507
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009508 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9509 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9510 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9511 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009512 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009513 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9514 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9515 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9516 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9517 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9518 HTTP header.
9519
9520 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9521 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009522 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009523 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9524 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9525 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9526 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9527 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9528 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9529 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9530
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009531 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9532 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9533 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9534 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9535 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9536 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9537
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009538 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9539 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9540 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9541 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9542
9543 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9544 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9545 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9546 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9547 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9548 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9549
9550 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9551 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9552 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9553 there are two methods :
9554
9555 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9556 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9557 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9558 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9559 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9560 of the client ranges may be used.
9561
9562 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9563 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9564 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9565 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9566 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9567 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9568 same session.
9569
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009570 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9571 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9572 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009573 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009574
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009575 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9576
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009577 Examples :
9578 backend private
9579 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9580 source 192.168.1.200
9581
9582 backend transparent_ssl1
9583 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9584 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9585
9586 backend transparent_ssl2
9587 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9588 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9589 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9590
9591 backend transparent_ssl3
9592 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9593 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9594 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9595
9596 backend transparent_smtp
9597 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9598 # with Tproxy version 4.
9599 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9600
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009601 backend transparent_http
9602 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9603 # proxy.
9604 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009606 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009607 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9608
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009609
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009610srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9611 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9612 the connection on the server side.
9613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9614 yes | no | yes | yes
9615 Arguments :
9616 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9617
9618 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9619 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009620 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9621 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009622
9623 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9624
9625
9626srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9627 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9628 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9629 server side.
9630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9631 yes | no | yes | yes
9632 Arguments :
9633 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9634 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9635 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9636 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9637
9638 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9639 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009640 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9641 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009642
9643 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9644
9645
9646srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9647 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | no | yes | yes
9650 Arguments :
9651 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9652 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9653 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9654 document.
9655
9656 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9657 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009658 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9659 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009660
9661 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9662
9663
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009664stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9665 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009667 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009668
9669 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9670 matched.
9671
9672 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9673 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9674
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009675 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9676 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009678
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009679 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9680 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9681 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9682 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009683
9684 Example :
9685 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9686 backend stats_localhost
9687 stats enable
9688 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9689
9690 Example :
9691 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9692 backend stats_auth
9693 stats enable
9694 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9695 stats admin if TRUE
9696
9697 Example :
9698 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9699 userlist stats-auth
9700 group admin users admin
9701 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9702 group readonly users haproxy
9703 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9704
9705 backend stats_auth
9706 stats enable
9707 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9708 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9709 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9710 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9711
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009712 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9713 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9714 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009715
9716
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009717stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9718 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009721 Arguments :
9722 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9723
9724 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9725
9726 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9727 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9728 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9729 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9730 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9731 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9732
9733 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9734 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9735 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009736 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009737
9738 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9739 report using "stats scope".
9740
9741 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9742 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9743 unobvious parameters.
9744
9745 Example :
9746 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9747 backend public_www
9748 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9749 stats enable
9750 stats hide-version
9751 stats scope .
9752 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009753 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009754 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9755 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9756
9757 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9758 backend private_monitoring
9759 stats enable
9760 stats uri /admin?stats
9761 stats refresh 5s
9762
9763 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9764
9765
9766stats enable
9767 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009769 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009770 Arguments : none
9771
9772 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9773 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9774 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9775 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9776 - stats auth : no authentication
9777 - stats scope : no restriction
9778
9779 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9780 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9781 unobvious parameters.
9782
9783 Example :
9784 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9785 backend public_www
9786 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9787 stats enable
9788 stats hide-version
9789 stats scope .
9790 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009791 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009792 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9793 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9794
9795 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9796 backend private_monitoring
9797 stats enable
9798 stats uri /admin?stats
9799 stats refresh 5s
9800
9801 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9802
9803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009804stats hide-version
9805 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009808 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009809
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009810 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9811 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9812 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9813 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9814 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9815 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009817 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9818 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9819 unobvious parameters.
9820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009821 Example :
9822 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9823 backend public_www
9824 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009825 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009826 stats hide-version
9827 stats scope .
9828 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009829 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009830 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9831 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009832
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009833 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9834 backend private_monitoring
9835 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009836 stats uri /admin?stats
9837 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009838
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009839 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009840
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009841
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009842stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9843 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9844 Access control for statistics
9845
9846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9847 no | no | yes | yes
9848
9849 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9850 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9851 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9852 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9853 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9854 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9855
9856 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9857 instance.
9858
9859 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9860 about ACL usage.
9861
9862
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009863stats realm <realm>
9864 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009866 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009867 Arguments :
9868 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9869 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9870 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9871
9872 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9873 using a backslash ('\').
9874
9875 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9876 only related to authentication.
9877
9878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9880 unobvious parameters.
9881
9882 Example :
9883 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9884 backend public_www
9885 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9886 stats enable
9887 stats hide-version
9888 stats scope .
9889 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009890 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009891 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9892 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9893
9894 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9895 backend private_monitoring
9896 stats enable
9897 stats uri /admin?stats
9898 stats refresh 5s
9899
9900 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9901
9902
9903stats refresh <delay>
9904 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009906 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009907 Arguments :
9908 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9909 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9910 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9911 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9912 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9913 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9914
9915 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9916 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9917 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -05009918 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009919
9920 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9921 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9922 unobvious parameters.
9923
9924 Example :
9925 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9926 backend public_www
9927 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9928 stats enable
9929 stats hide-version
9930 stats scope .
9931 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009932 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009933 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9934 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9935
9936 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9937 backend private_monitoring
9938 stats enable
9939 stats uri /admin?stats
9940 stats refresh 5s
9941
9942 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9943
9944
9945stats scope { <name> | "." }
9946 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009948 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009949 Arguments :
9950 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9951 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9952 section in which the statement appears.
9953
9954 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9955 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9956 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9957 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9958 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9959 exists.
9960
9961 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9962 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9963 unobvious parameters.
9964
9965 Example :
9966 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9967 backend public_www
9968 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9969 stats enable
9970 stats hide-version
9971 stats scope .
9972 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009973 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009974 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9975 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9976
9977 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9978 backend private_monitoring
9979 stats enable
9980 stats uri /admin?stats
9981 stats refresh 5s
9982
9983 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9984
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009985
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009986stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009987 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009989 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009990
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009991 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009992 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9993
9994 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9995 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9996
9997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009999 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010000
10001 Example :
10002 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10003 backend private_monitoring
10004 stats enable
10005 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10006 stats uri /admin?stats
10007 stats refresh 5s
10008
10009 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10010 global section.
10011
10012
10013stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010014 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10016 yes | yes | yes | yes
10017 Arguments : none
10018
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010019 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010020 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10021 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10022 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10023 - IP (socket, server)
10024 - cookie (backend, server)
10025
10026 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10027 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010028 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010029
10030 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10031
10032
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010033stats show-modules
10034 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | yes | yes | yes
10037 Arguments : none
10038
10039 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10040 values as a tooltip.
10041
10042 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10043 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10044 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10045
10046 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10047
10048
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010049stats show-node [ <name> ]
10050 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010052 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010053 Arguments:
10054 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10055 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10056
10057 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10058 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010059 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010060
10061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10063 unobvious parameters.
10064
10065 Example:
10066 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10067 backend private_monitoring
10068 stats enable
10069 stats show-node Europe-1
10070 stats uri /admin?stats
10071 stats refresh 5s
10072
10073 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10074 section.
10075
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010076
10077stats uri <prefix>
10078 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010080 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010081 Arguments :
10082 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10083 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10084 query string.
10085
10086 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10087 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10088 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10089 possible to reach it in the application.
10090
10091 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010092 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010093 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10094 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10095 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10096 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10097
10098 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10099 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10100 an address or a port to statistics only.
10101
10102 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10103 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10104 unobvious parameters.
10105
10106 Example :
10107 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10108 backend public_www
10109 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10110 stats enable
10111 stats hide-version
10112 stats scope .
10113 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010114 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010115 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10116 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10117
10118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10119 backend private_monitoring
10120 stats enable
10121 stats uri /admin?stats
10122 stats refresh 5s
10123
10124 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10125
10126
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010127stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10128 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010130 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010131
10132 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010133 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010134 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010135 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010136 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10137
10138 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10139 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10140 the "stick-table" statement.
10141
10142 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10143 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10144 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10145 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10146 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10147
10148 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10149 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10150 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10151 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10152 transformation rules.
10153
10154 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10155 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10156 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10157 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10158 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10159 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10160 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10161
10162 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10163 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10164 ACL based conditions.
10165
10166 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10167 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10168 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10169 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10170
10171 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10172 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10173 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10174 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10175
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010176 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10177 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010178 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010179
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010180 Example :
10181 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10182 # last 30 minutes
10183 backend pop
10184 mode tcp
10185 balance roundrobin
10186 stick store-request src
10187 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10188 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10189 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10190
10191 backend smtp
10192 mode tcp
10193 balance roundrobin
10194 stick match src table pop
10195 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10196 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10197
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010198 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010199 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010200
10201
10202stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10203 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10205 no | no | yes | yes
10206
10207 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10208 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10209 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10210 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010212 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10213 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010214 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010215
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010216 Examples :
10217 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010218 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010219
10220 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10221 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10222 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10223
10224
10225 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10226 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10227 backend http
10228 mode http
10229 balance roundrobin
10230 stick on src table https
10231 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10232 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10233 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10234
10235 backend https
10236 mode tcp
10237 balance roundrobin
10238 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10239 stick on src
10240 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10241 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10242
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010243 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010244
10245
10246stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10247 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 no | no | yes | yes
10250
10251 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010252 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010253 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010254 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010255 server is selected.
10256
10257 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10258 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10259 the "stick-table" statement.
10260
10261 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10262 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10263 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10264 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10265 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10266 address.
10267
10268 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10269 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10270 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10271 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10272 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10273 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10274 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10275 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10276 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10277 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10278
10279 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10280 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10281 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10282 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10283 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10284 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10285 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10286
10287 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10288 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10289 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10290 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10291
10292 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10293 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10294 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10295 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10296 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10297 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010298 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10299 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10300 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10301 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10302 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10303 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010304
10305 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10306 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10307 the request.
10308
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010309 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10310 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010311 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010312
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010313 Example :
10314 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10315 # last 30 minutes
10316 backend pop
10317 mode tcp
10318 balance roundrobin
10319 stick store-request src
10320 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10321 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10322 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10323
10324 backend smtp
10325 mode tcp
10326 balance roundrobin
10327 stick match src table pop
10328 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10329 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10330
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010331 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010332 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010333
10334
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010335stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010336 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10337 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010338 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010340 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010341
10342 Arguments :
10343 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10344 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10345 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10346 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10347
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010348 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10349 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10350 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10351 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10352
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010353 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10354 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10355 instance.
10356
10357 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10358 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10359 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10360 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10361 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10362 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010363 to 32 characters.
10364
10365 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10366 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10367 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010368 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010369 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10370 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010371
10372 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010373 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10374 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010375 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10376 increase.
10377
10378 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010379 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10380 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10381 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010382
10383 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10384 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10385 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10386 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010387 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010388 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10389 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10390 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10391 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10392 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10393 parameter (see below).
10394
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010395 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10396 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10397 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10398 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10399 soft restart.
10400
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010401 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10402 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010403
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010404 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10405 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10406 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10407 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010408 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010409 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010410 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10411 if not expiration delay is specified.
10412
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010413 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10414 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10415 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10416 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010417 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10418 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10419 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10420 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10421 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10422 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10423 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10424 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10425 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10426 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10427 types and their arguments.
10428
10429 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10430 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10431 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10432 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10433
10434 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10435 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10436 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010437 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010438
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010439 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10440 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10441 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010442 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010443 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010444 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010445
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010446 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10447 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10448 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10449 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10450
10451 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10452 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10453 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10454 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10455 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10456 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10457
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010458 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10459 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10460 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10461 they were received.
10462
10463 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10464 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10465 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10466 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10467 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10468
10469 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10470 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10471 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10472 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10473 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10474
10475 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10476 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10477 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10478
10479 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10480 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10481 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10482 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10483 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10484
10485 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10486 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10487 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10488 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10489 the client side.
10490
10491 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10492 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10493 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10494 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10495 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10496 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10497 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10498
10499 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10500 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10501 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10502 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10503 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10504 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010505 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010506
10507 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10508 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10509 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10510 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10511 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10512 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10513
10514 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010515 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010516 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10517 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10518
10519 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10520 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10521 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10522 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10523 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10524 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10525 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10526 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10527 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10528 recommended for better fairness.
10529
10530 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010531 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010532 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10533 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10534
10535 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10536 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10537 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10538 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10539 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10540 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10541 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10542 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10543 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10544 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010545
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010546 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10547 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010548 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10549 reference it.
10550
10551 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10552 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010553 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10554 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10555 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010556
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010557 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10558 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10559 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10560 something that can be ignored.
10561
10562 Example:
10563 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10564 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10565 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10566 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10567
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010568 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010569 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010570
10571
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010572stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010573 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10575 no | no | yes | yes
10576
10577 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010578 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010579 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010580 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010581 server is selected.
10582
10583 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10584 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10585 the "stick-table" statement.
10586
10587 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10588 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10589 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10590 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10591
10592 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10593 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10594 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10595 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10596 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10597 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010598 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010599 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10600 rules.
10601
10602 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10603 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10604 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10605 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10606 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10607 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10608 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10609
10610 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10611 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10612 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10613 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10614
10615 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10616 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10617 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10618 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10619 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10620 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010621 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10622 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10623 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10624 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10625 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10626 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10627 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10628 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10629 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010630
10631 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10632
10633 Example :
10634 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10635 backend https
10636 mode tcp
10637 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010638 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010639 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010640
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010641 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10642 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10643
10644 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10645 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10646 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10647
10648 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10649 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010650
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010651 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10652 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10653 # at offset 44.
10654
10655 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10656 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10657
10658 # Learn on response if server hello.
10659 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010660
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010661 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10662 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10663
10664 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10665 extraction.
10666
10667
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010668tcp-check comment <string>
10669 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10670 it fails.
10671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10672 yes | no | yes | yes
10673
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010674 Arguments :
10675 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10676 rule fails.
10677
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010678 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10679 user-friendly error reporting.
10680
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010681 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10682 "tcp-check expect".
10683
10684
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010685tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10686 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010687 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010688 Opens a new connection
10689 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010690 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010691
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010692 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010693 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10694
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010695 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010696 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010697
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010698 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010699 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10700 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010701 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010702
10703 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010704
10705 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10706
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010707 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10708
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010709 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10710
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010711 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10712
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010713 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10714 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10715 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10716 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10717
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010718 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10719 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10720 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10721 haproxy -vv.
10722
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010723 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010725 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10726 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10727 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10728
10729 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10730 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10731 of the sequence.
10732
10733 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10734 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10735 do.
10736
10737 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10738 unset-var or comment rules.
10739
10740 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010741 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10742 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10743 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10744 option tcp-check
10745 tcp-check connect
10746 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10747 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10748 tcp-check send \r\n
10749 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10750 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10751 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10752 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10753 tcp-check send \r\n
10754 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10755 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10756
10757 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10758 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010759 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010760 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10761 tcp-check connect port 143
10762 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10763 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10764
10765 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10766
10767
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010768tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010769 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010770 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010771 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010772 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010773 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010774 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010775
10776 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010777 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10778
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010779 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10780 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10781 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10782 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10783 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10784 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10785 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10786 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10787 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10788 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10789
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010790 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010791 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10792 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010793 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10794 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10795 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10796
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010797 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10798 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10799 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010800 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10801 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10802 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10803 example 404 with disable-on-404
10804 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10805 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010806 By default "L7OK" is used.
10807
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010808 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10809 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010810 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10811 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10812 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10813 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10814 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10815 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010816
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010817 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010818 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010819 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10820 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10821 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10822 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010823 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10824
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010825 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10826 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10827 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10828 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10829
10830 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10831 informational message reported in logs if an error
10832 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10833 log-format string.
10834
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010835 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10836 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10837 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10838 followed by some converters.
10839
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010840 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10841 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10842 with the usual backslash ('\').
10843 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010845 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10846 used upper or lower case.
10847
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010848 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10849
10850 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10851 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10852 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10853 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10854 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10855 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10856 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10857 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10858
10859 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10860 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10861 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10862 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10863 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10864 expression.
10865
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010866 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10867 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10868 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10869 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10870 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10871 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10872
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010873 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10874 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10875 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10876 this exact hexadecimal string.
10877 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10878
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010879 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10880 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10881 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10882 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10883 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10884 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10885 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10886 size.
10887
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010888 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10889 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10890 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10891 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10892 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10893 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10894 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10895 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10896 in a binary string before matching the response's
10897 buffer.
10898
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010899 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10900 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10901 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10902 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10903 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10904 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10905 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10906 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10907 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10908 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10909 the null character.
10910
10911 Examples :
10912 # perform a POP check
10913 option tcp-check
10914 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10915
10916 # perform an IMAP check
10917 option tcp-check
10918 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10919
10920 # look for the redis master server
10921 option tcp-check
10922 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010923 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010924 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10925 tcp-check expect string role:master
10926 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10927 tcp-check expect string +OK
10928
10929
10930 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10931 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10932
10933
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010934tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10935tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10936 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10937 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010938 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010939 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010940
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010941 Arguments :
10942 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10943
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010944 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10945 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010946
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010947 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10948 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010949
10950 Examples :
10951 # look for the redis master server
10952 option tcp-check
10953 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10954 tcp-check expect string role:master
10955
10956 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10957 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10958
10959
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010960tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10961tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10962 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10963 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010966
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010967 Arguments :
10968 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010969
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010970 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10971 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010972
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010973 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10974 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10975 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010976
10977 Examples :
10978 # redis check in binary
10979 option tcp-check
10980 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10981 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10982
10983
10984 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10985 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10986
10987
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010988tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010989 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010990 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010991 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010992
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010993 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010994 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10995 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10996 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10997 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10998 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10999 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11000 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11001 and '-'.
11002
11003 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11004
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011005 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011006 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11007
11008
11009tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011010 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011012 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011014 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011015 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11016 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11019 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11021 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11022 and '-'.
11023
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011024 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011025 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11026
11027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011028tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11029 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11031 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011032 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011033 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11034 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011035
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011036 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011037
11038 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11039 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011040 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11041 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11042 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11043 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11044 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11045 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011047 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11048 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11049 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11050 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011051
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011052 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011053 - accept :
11054 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11055 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11056 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011058 - reject :
11059 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11060 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11061 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11062 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11063 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11064 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11065 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11066 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11067 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11068 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11069 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011070 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011071
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011072 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11073 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11074 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11075 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11076 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11077 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11078 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11079 hosts.
11080
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011081 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11082 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11083 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11084 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11085 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11086 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11087 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11088 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11089
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011090 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11091 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11092 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11093 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11094 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11095 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11096 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11097 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11098 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011099 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11100 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011101
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011102 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011103 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011104 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11105 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11106 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011107 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011108 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011109 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11110 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11111 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11112 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11113 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11114 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11115 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011117 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011118 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011119 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011120 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011121 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11122 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11123 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011125 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11126 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11127 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11128 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11131 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11132 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11133 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11134 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011135 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11136 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11137 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11138 layer7 information is extracted.
11139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011140 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11141 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11142 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11143 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11144 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011145
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011146 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11147 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11148 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11149 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11150
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011151 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11152 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11153 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11154 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11155
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011156 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11157 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11158 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11159 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11160 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011161
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011162 - set-src <expr> :
11163 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11164 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11165 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011166 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011168 Arguments:
11169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11170 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011171
11172 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011173 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11174
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011175 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11176 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011177
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011178 - set-src-port <expr> :
11179 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11180 expression.
11181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011182 Arguments:
11183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11184 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011185
11186 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011187 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11188
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011189 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11190 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11191 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011192
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011193 - set-dst <expr> :
11194 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11195 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11196 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11197 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11198 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11199
11200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11201 followed by some converters.
11202
11203 Example:
11204
11205 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11206 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11207
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011208 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11209 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11210
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011211 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11212 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11213 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11214 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11215
11216
11217 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11218 followed by some converters.
11219
11220 Example:
11221
11222 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11223
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011224 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11225 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11226 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11227
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011228 - "silent-drop" :
11229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011230 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011231 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11232 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11233 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11234 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11235 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011236 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11237 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011238 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11239 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011240 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011241 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11242 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11243 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11244 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011246 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11247 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11248 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011250 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11251 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11252 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011254 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011255 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011256 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011258 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11259 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11260 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011261
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011262 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011263 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11264 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011265
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011266 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11267
11268 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11269
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011270 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11271
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011272 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011273
11274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011275tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11276 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011278 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011280 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11281 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011283 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011284
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011286 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11287 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11288 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11289 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011290
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011291 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11292 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11293 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11294 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011295 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11296 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11297 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11298 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11299 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11300 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011301 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011302 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011304 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11305 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11306 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11307 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011308
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011309 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011310 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011311 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011312 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11313 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011314 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011315 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011316 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011317 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011318 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011319 - set-dst <expr>
11320 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011321 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011322 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011323 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011324 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011325 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011326
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011327 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11328 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011329 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11330 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011331
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011332 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11333 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11334 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11335 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11336 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11337 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011339 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011340 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11341 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011342
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011343 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11344 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11345 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11346 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11347 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11348 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11349
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011350 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011351 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11352 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11353 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11354 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11355 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11356 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11357 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11358 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11359 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11360 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011361
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011362 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011363 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11364 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11365 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011366
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011367 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11368 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11369
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011370 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011371 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11372 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011373
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011374 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11375 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011376 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011377 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11378 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011379 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011380 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011381 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011382 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11383 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011384 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011385 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11386 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011387
11388 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11389 followed by some converters.
11390
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011391 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11392 <var-name>.
11393
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011394 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11395 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11396 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11397 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11398 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11399
11400 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11401 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11402 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11403 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11404 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11405 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11406 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11407 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11408 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11409 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11410 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11411
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011412 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11413 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11414 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11415 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11416 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11417
11418 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11419
11420 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11421
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011422 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11423 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11424 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11425 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11426 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11427 evaluated.
11428
11429 Example:
11430 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11431
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011432 Example:
11433
11434 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011435 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011436
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011437 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011438 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11439 # and reject everything else.
11440 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11441 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011442 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011443 tcp-request content reject
11444
11445 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011446 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11447 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11448 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011449 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011450
11451 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11452 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11453 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011454 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011455 tcp-request content reject
11456
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011457 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011458 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011459 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011460 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011461 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11462 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011463
11464 Example:
11465 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11466 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011467 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011468
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011469 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011470 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011471
11472 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011473 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011474 # protecting all our sites
11475 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011476 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11477 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011478 ...
11479 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11480
11481 backend http_dynamic
11482 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011483 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011484 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011485 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011486 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011487 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011488 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011489
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011490 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011491
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011492 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11493 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011494
11495
11496tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11497 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011499 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011500 Arguments :
11501 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11502 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11503 as explained at the top of this document.
11504
11505 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11506 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11507 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11508 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11509 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11510
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011511 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11512 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11513 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11514 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11515
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011516 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11517 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011518 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011519 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011520 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11521 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11522 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11523 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011524
11525 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11526 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11527 it pass through unaffected.
11528
11529 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11530 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11531 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011532 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011533 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11534 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011535 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11536 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11537 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011538
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011539 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011540 "timeout client".
11541
11542
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011543tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11544 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11546 no | no | yes | yes
11547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011548 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11549 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011550
11551 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11552
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011553 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011554 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11555 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011556 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11557 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011558
11559 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11560
11561 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11562 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11563 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11564 inserted.
11565
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011566 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011567 - accept :
11568 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11569 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11570 the rules evaluation.
11571
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011572 - close :
11573 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11574 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11575 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11576 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11577 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11578 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011579 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011580 protocols.
11581
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011582 - reject :
11583 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11584 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011585 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011586
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011587 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11588 Sets a variable.
11589
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011590 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11591 Unsets a variable.
11592
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011593 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11594 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11595 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11596 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11597
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011598 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11599 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11601 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11602
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011603 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11604 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11605 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11606 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11607 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011608
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011609 - "silent-drop" :
11610 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011612 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11613 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11614 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11615 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11616 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011617 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11618 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011619 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11620 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011621 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011622 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11623 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11624 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11625 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11626
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011627 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11628 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11629
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011630 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11631 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11632 for changing the default action to a reject.
11633
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011634 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11635 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11636 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11637 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011638 period.
11639
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011640 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11641 declared inline.
11642
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011643 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11644 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011645 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011646 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11647 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011648 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011649 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011650 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011651 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11652 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011653 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011654 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11655 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011656
11657 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11658 followed by some converters.
11659
11660 Example:
11661
11662 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11663
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011664 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11665 <var-name>.
11666
11667 Example:
11668
11669 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11670
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011671 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11672 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11673 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11674 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11675 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11676
11677 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11678
11679 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11680
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011681 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11682
11683 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11684
11685
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011686tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11687 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11689 no | yes | yes | no
11690 Arguments :
11691 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11692 below.
11693
11694 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011696 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011697 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11698 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11699 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11700 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11701 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11702 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11703 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011704 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011705 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11706 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11707 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11708 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11709 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11710 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11711 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11712 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11713 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11714 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11715 instead.
11716
11717 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11718 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11719 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11720 rules which may be inserted.
11721
11722 Several types of actions are supported :
11723 - accept : the request is accepted
11724 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11725 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11726 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011727 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011728 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011729 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011730 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011731 - silent-drop
11732
11733 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11734 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11735 sections for a complete description.
11736
11737 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11738 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11739 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11740
11741 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11742 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11743 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11744 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11745 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11746
11747 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11748 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11749
11750 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11751 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11752 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11753
11754 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11755 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11756 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11757
11758 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11759 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11760 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11761
11762 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11763 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11764 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11765
11766 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11767
11768 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11769
11770
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011771tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11772 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11774 no | no | yes | yes
11775 Arguments :
11776 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11777 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11778 as explained at the top of this document.
11779
11780 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11781
11782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011783timeout check <timeout>
11784 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11785 established.
11786
11787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11788 yes | no | yes | yes
11789 Arguments:
11790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11792 as explained at the top of this document.
11793
11794 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11795 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011796 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011797 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011798 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11799 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11800 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011801
11802 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11803 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11804
11805 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11806 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011807 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011808
11809 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11810 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11811 forget about it.
11812
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011813 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11814 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011815
11816
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011817timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011818 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11820 yes | yes | yes | no
11821 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011822 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011823 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11824 as explained at the top of this document.
11825
11826 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11827 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11828 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011829 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11830 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11831 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11832 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011833 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11834 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11835 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011836 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011837 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011838 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11839 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011840 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11841 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011842
11843 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011847 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11849
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011850 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011851
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011852 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011854
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011855timeout client-fin <timeout>
11856 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11858 yes | yes | yes | no
11859 Arguments :
11860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11862 as explained at the top of this document.
11863
11864 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11865 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11866 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11867 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11868 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11869 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11870 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011871 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11872 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11873 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011874
11875 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11876 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11877 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11878
11879 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11880
11881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011882timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011883 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11885 yes | no | yes | yes
11886 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11889 as explained at the top of this document.
11890
11891 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011892 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011893 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011894 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011895 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11896 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011897
11898 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11899 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11900 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11901 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011902 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011903 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11904
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011905 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011906
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011907
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011908timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11909 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11911 yes | yes | yes | yes
11912 Arguments :
11913 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11914 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11915 as explained at the top of this document.
11916
11917 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11918 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11919 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11920 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11921 once the request has started to present itself.
11922
11923 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11924 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11925 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11926 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11927 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11928
11929 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11930 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11931 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11932 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11933
11934 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11935 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011936 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011937 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11938 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011939 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011940
11941 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11942 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11943 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11944 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11945
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011946 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11947 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011948 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11949
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011950 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11951
11952
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011953timeout http-request <timeout>
11954 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011956 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011957 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011958 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011959 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11960 as explained at the top of this document.
11961
11962 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11963 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11964 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11965 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11966 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11967 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11968 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011969 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11970 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11971 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11972 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011973 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011974 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11975 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011976
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011977 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11978 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11979 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11980 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11981 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011982 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011983
11984 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11985 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011986 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011987 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11988 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11989
11990 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011991 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11992 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11993 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011994
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011995 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011996 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011997
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011998
11999timeout queue <timeout>
12000 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12002 yes | no | yes | yes
12003 Arguments :
12004 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12005 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12006 as explained at the top of this document.
12007
12008 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12009 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12010 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12011 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12012 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12013
12014 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12015 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12016 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12017 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12018
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012019 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012020
12021
12022timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012023 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12025 yes | no | yes | yes
12026 Arguments :
12027 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12028 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12029 as explained at the top of this document.
12030
12031 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12032 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12033 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12034 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12035 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12036 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12037 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12038
12039 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12040 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12041 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12042 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12043 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012044 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012045 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012046 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12047 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012048 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12049 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012050
12051 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12052 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12053 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12054 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012055 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012056 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12057
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012058 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012059
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012060
12061timeout server-fin <timeout>
12062 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12064 yes | no | yes | yes
12065 Arguments :
12066 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12067 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12068 as explained at the top of this document.
12069
12070 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12071 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12072 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12073 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12074 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12075 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12076 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12077 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12078 situations, it should not be needed.
12079
12080 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12081 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12082 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12083
12084 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12085
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012086
12087timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012088 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12090 yes | yes | yes | yes
12091 Arguments :
12092 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12093 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12094 as explained at the top of this document.
12095
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012096 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12097 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12098 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012099
12100 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12101 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12102 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12103 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012104 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012105
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012106 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012107
12108
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012109timeout tunnel <timeout>
12110 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12112 yes | no | yes | yes
12113 Arguments :
12114 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12115 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12116 as explained at the top of this document.
12117
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012118 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012119 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12120 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12121 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12123 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012124 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12125 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12126 specified.
12127
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012128 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12129 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12130 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12131 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12132 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12133 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12134 state.
12135
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012136 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12137 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12138 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12139 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012140 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012141
12142 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12143 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12144 forget about it.
12145
12146 Example :
12147 defaults http
12148 option http-server-close
12149 timeout connect 5s
12150 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012151 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012152 timeout server 30s
12153 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12154
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012155 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012156
12157
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012158transparent (deprecated)
12159 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012161 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012162 Arguments : none
12163
12164 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12165 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12166 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12167 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12168 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12169 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12170 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12171 appropriate server.
12172
12173 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12174
12175 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12176 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12177
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012178 See also: "option transparent"
12179
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012180unique-id-format <string>
12181 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12183 yes | yes | yes | no
12184 Arguments :
12185 <string> is a log-format string.
12186
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012187 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12188 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12189 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12190 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012191
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012192 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12193 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12194 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12195 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12196 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12197 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12198 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12199 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012200
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012201 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12202 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012204 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012205
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012206 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012207
12208 will generate:
12209
12210 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12211
12212 See also: "unique-id-header"
12213
12214unique-id-header <name>
12215 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12217 yes | yes | yes | no
12218 Arguments :
12219 <name> is the name of the header.
12220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012221 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12222 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012224 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012225
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012226 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012227 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12228
12229 will generate:
12230
12231 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12232
12233 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012234
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012235use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012236 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12238 no | yes | yes | no
12239 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012240 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12241 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012242
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012243 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12244 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012245
12246 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12247 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12248 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012249 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012250 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012251 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12252 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012253
12254 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12255 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12256 assign the backend.
12257
12258 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12259 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12260 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12261 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12262 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12263 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12264
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012265 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012266 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012267 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12268 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12269 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12270
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012271 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12272 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12273 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12274 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12275 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12276 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12277 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12278 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12279 cannot be forced from the request.
12280
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012281 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012282 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12283 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12284
12285 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12286 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012287
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012288use-fcgi-app <name>
12289 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12291 no | no | yes | yes
12292 Arguments :
12293 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12294
12295 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012296
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012297use-server <server> if <condition>
12298use-server <server> unless <condition>
12299 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12301 no | no | yes | yes
12302 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012303 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12304 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012305
12306 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12307
12308 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12309 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12310 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12311
12312 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12313 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12314 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12315 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12316 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12317 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12318 matches will assign the server.
12319
12320 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12321 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12322 with the next rules until one matches.
12323
12324 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12325 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12326 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12327 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12328
12329 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12330 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12331 stripped.
12332
12333 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12334 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012335 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12336 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12337 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012338
12339 Example :
12340 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12341 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12342 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12343 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012344 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012345 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012346 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012347 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12348 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12349
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012350 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12351 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12352 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12353 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012354 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012355 and we fall back to load balancing.
12356
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012357 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012358
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100123605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012361--------------------------
12362
12363The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12364depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12365settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12366written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12367described in this section.
12368
12369
123705.1. Bind options
12371-----------------
12372
12373The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12374as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12375no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12376parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12377while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12378provided immediately after the setting name.
12379
12380The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12381
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012382accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12383 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12384 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12385 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12386 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12387 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12388 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12389 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12390 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12391 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012392 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12393 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12394 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012396accept-proxy
12397 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012398 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12399 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012400 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12401 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12402 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12403 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012404 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012405 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12406 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012407 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12408 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012409
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012410allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012411 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012412 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012413 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012414 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12415 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012416
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012417alpn <protocols>
12418 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12419 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12420 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012421 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012422 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012423 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12424 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12425 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12426 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12427 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12428 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12429 preference, like below :
12430
12431 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012432
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012433backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012434 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012435 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12436
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012437curves <curves>
12438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12439 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12440 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12441 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12442 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12443 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12444
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012445ecdhe <named curve>
12446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012447 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12448 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012449
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012450ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12452 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12453 client's certificate.
12454
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012455ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12457 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12458 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12459 error is ignored.
12460
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012461ca-sign-file <cafile>
12462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12463 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12464 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12465 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12466 'generate-certificates' for details.
12467
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012468ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12470 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12471 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12472 'generate-certificates' for details.
12473
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012474ca-verify-file <cafile>
12475 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12476 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12477 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12478 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12479 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012481ciphers <ciphers>
12482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12483 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012484 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012485 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012486 information and recommendations see e.g.
12487 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12488 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12489 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12490
12491ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12492 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12493 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12494 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12495 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012496 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12497 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012498
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012499crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012500 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12501 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12502 to verify client's certificate.
12503
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012504crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12506 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12507 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12508 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12509 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012510 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12511 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012512
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012513 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12514 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12515
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012516 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12517 are loaded.
12518
12519 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012520 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12521 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12522 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12523 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12524 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12525 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12526 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012527 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012528
12529 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12530 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12531 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12532 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012533 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12534 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012535
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012536 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012537
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012538 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012539 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012540 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12541 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012542 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12543 clients).
12544
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012545 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12546 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12547 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12548 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12549 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12550 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12551 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12552 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12553 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12554 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12555 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12556 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12557 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12558
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012559 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12560 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12561 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12562 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12563 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12564
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012565 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12566 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12567 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12568 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012569
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012570 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12571 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12572 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012573
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012574crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012576 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012577 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012578 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012579
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012580crt-list <file>
12581 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012582 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12583 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012584
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012585 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12586
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012587 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12588 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12589 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12590 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12591 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012592
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012593 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12594 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12595 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12596 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12597 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12598 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12599 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12600 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012601
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012602 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12603 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12604 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012605
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012606 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12607
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012608 crt-list file example:
12609 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012610 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012611 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012612 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012613 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012614
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012615defer-accept
12616 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12617 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12618 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012619 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012620 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12621 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12622 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12623 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12624 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12625 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12626 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12627
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012628expose-fd listeners
12629 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12630 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012631 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12632 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012633 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012634
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012635force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012636 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012637 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012638 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012639 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012640
12641force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012642 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012643 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012644 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012645
12646force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012647 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012648 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012649 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012650
12651force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012652 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012653 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012654 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012655
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012656force-tlsv13
12657 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12658 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012659 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012660
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012661generate-certificates
12662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12663 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12664 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12665 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12666 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12667 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12668 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12669 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12670 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12671 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12672 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12673
12674 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12675 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012676 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012677 certificate is used many times.
12678
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012679gid <gid>
12680 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12681 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12682 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12683 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12684 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12685
12686group <group>
12687 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12688 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12689 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12690 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12691 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12692
12693id <id>
12694 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12695 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12696 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12697 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12698
12699interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012700 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12701 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12702 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12703 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12704 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12705 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012706 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12707 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12708 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12709 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12710 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12711 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012712
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012713level <level>
12714 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12715 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12716 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012718 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12719 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12720 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012721 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012722 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012723 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012724 all counters).
12725
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012726severity-output <format>
12727 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12728 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12729 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12730 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12731 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12732 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12733 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12734 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12735 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12736 rfc5424 convention.
12737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012738maxconn <maxconn>
12739 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12740 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12741 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12742 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12743 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12744 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12745 eat all memory.
12746
12747mode <mode>
12748 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12749 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12750 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12751 UNIX sockets.
12752
12753mss <maxseg>
12754 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12755 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12756 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12757 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12758 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12759 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12760 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12761 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12762 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12763 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12764 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12765
12766name <name>
12767 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12768 page.
12769
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012770namespace <name>
12771 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12772 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12773 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12774 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12775
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012776nice <nice>
12777 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12778 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12779 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12780 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12781 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12782 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12783 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12784 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12785 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12786 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12787 one for an RDP socket.
12788
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012789no-ca-names
12790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12791 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012792 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012793
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012794no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012795 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012796 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012798 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012799 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12800 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012801
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012802no-tls-tickets
12803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12804 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12805 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012806 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12807 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012808 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12809 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12810 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012811
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012812no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012814 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012815 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012816 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012817 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12818 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012819
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012820no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012822 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012823 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012824 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012825 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12826 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012827
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012828no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012830 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012831 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012832 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012833 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12834 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012835
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012836no-tlsv13
12837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12838 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12839 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12840 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012841 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12842 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012843
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012844npn <protocols>
12845 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12846 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12847 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012848 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012849 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012850 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12851 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12852 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12853 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12854 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012855
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012856prefer-client-ciphers
12857 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12858 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12859 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012860 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12861 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12862 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012863
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012864process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012865 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012866 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012867 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012868 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12869 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12870 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12871 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012873 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12874 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12875 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12876 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12877 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012878
12879 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12880
12881 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12882 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12883 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12884 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12885 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12886 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12887 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12888 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012889
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012890proto <name>
12891 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12892 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12893 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12894 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012895 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012896 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012897 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012898 h2" on the bind line.
12899
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012900ssl
12901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012902 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012903 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12904 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012905 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12906 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012907
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012908ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12909 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012910 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12911 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12912 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012913 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12914
12915ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012916 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12917 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12918 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12919 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012920
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012921strict-sni
12922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12923 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12924 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12925 See the "crt" option for more information.
12926
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012927tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012928 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012929 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12930 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012931 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012932 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12933 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12934 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12935 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12936 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12937 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12938 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12939
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012940tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012941 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012942 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12943 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12944 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12945 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12946 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12947 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12948 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012949 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12950 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12951 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012952
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012953tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12954 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012955 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12956 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12957 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12958 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12959 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12960 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12961 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12962 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12963 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12964 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012965 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12966 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12967
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012968transparent
12969 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12970 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12971 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12972 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12973 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12974 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12975 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12976 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12977 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12978 so check for support with your vendor.
12979
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012980v4v6
12981 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12982 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12983 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12984 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012985 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012986
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012987v6only
12988 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12989 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12990 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012991 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12992 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012993
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012994uid <uid>
12995 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12996 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12997 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12998 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12999 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13000
13001user <user>
13002 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13003 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13004 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13005 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13006 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13007
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013008verify [none|optional|required]
13009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13010 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13011 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13012 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13013 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013014 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13015 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13016 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13017 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200130195.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013020------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013021
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013022The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13023which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13024arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13025settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13026after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13027Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13028address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013030 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013031 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013033Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13034keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013036The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013037
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013038addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013039 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013040 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13041 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13042 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13043 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13044 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013045
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013046agent-check
13047 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013048 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013049 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13050 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13051 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013052
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013053 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013054 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013055 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13056 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13057 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013058
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013059 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13060 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13061 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13062 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13063 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013064
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013065 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013066 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013067
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013068 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13069 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13070 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013071
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013072 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13073 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13074 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013075
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013076 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013077 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13078 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13079 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13080 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013082 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013083
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013084 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13085 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013086
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013087 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13088 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13089 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13090 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13091 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13092 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13093 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13094 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13095 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013096
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013097 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13098 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013099 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13100 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13101 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013102 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013103
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013104 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013105 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013106
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013107agent-send <string>
13108 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13109 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13110 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13111 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13112 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13113
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013114agent-inter <delay>
13115 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13116 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13117
13118 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13119 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13120 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13121 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13122 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13123 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13124 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13125 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13126 of backends use the same servers.
13127
13128 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13129
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013130agent-addr <addr>
13131 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13132
13133 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13134 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13135 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13136 hostname, it will be resolved.
13137
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013138agent-port <port>
13139 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13140
13141 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13142
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013143allow-0rtt
13144 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013145 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13146 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013147
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013148alpn <protocols>
13149 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13150 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13151 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013152 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013153 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13154 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13155 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13156 now obsolete NPN extension.
13157 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13158 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13159
13160 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013162backup
13163 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13164 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13165 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13166 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013167 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13168 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013169
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013170ca-file <cafile>
13171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13172 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13173 server's certificate.
13174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013175check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013176 This option enables health checks on a server:
13177 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13178 considered available.
13179 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13180 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13181 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13182 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13183 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13184 set.
13185 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13186 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13187 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13188 exchanges succeed.
13189
13190 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13191 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13192 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13193 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13194 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013195 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013196 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13197
13198 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13199 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13200
13201 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13202 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13203
13204 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13205 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13206 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13207 available.
13208
13209 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13210 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13211 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13212
13213 Example:
13214 # simple tcp check
13215 backend foo
13216 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13217 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13218 backend foo
13219 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13220 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13221 backend foo
13222 option tcp-check
13223 tcp-check connect
13224 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013225
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013226check-send-proxy
13227 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13228 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13229 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13230 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13231 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13232 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13233 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13234
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013235check-alpn <protocols>
13236 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13237 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13238 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13239
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013240check-proto <name>
13241 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13242 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13243 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13244 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013245 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013246 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13247 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13248
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013249check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013250 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013251 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13252 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013253
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013254check-ssl
13255 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13256 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13257 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13258 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013259 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013260 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13261 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013262 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013263 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13264 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013265
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013266check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013267 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013268 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13269 for normal traffic.
13270
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013271ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13273 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13274 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013275 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13276 information and recommendations see e.g.
13277 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13278 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13279 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013280
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013281ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13283 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13284 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13285 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013286 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13287 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13288 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013290cookie <value>
13291 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13292 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13293 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13294 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13295 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13296 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13297 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13298
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013299crl-file <crlfile>
13300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13301 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13302 to verify server's certificate.
13303
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013304crt <cert>
13305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13306 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13307 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13308 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13309 certificate request.
13310
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013311disabled
13312 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13313 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13314 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13315 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13316 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013317 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013318
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013319enabled
13320 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13321 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13322 default value.
13323 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13324 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013326error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013327 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13328 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13329 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013331 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013333fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013334 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13335 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13336 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13337
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013338force-sslv3
13339 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13340 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013341 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013342 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013343
13344force-tlsv10
13345 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013346 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013347 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013348
13349force-tlsv11
13350 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013351 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013352 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013353
13354force-tlsv12
13355 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013356 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013357 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013358
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013359force-tlsv13
13360 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13361 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013362 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013364id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013365 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13366 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13367 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013368
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013369init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13370 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13371 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013372 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013373 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13374 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13375 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13376 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13377 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13378 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13379 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13380 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13381 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013382 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013383 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13384 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13385 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13386 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13387 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13388 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013389 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013390
13391 Example:
13392 defaults
13393 # never fail on address resolution
13394 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013396inter <delay>
13397fastinter <delay>
13398downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013399 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13400 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13401 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13402 between checks depending on the server state :
13403
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013404 Server state | Interval used
13405 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13406 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13407 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13408 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13409 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13410 or yet unchecked. |
13411 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13412 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13413 | "inter" otherwise.
13414 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013416 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13417 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13418 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13419 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013420 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13421 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13422 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13423 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13424 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013425
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013426log-proto <logproto>
13427 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13428 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13429 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13430 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013432maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013433 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13434 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013435 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13436 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013437 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13438 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13439 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13440 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13441
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013442 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13443 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13444 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13445 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13446 than 50 concurrent requests.
13447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013448maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013449 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13450 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13451 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13452 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13453 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13454 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13455 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13456
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013457max-reuse <count>
13458 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13459 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13460 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13461 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13462 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13463 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13464 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13465 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013467minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013468 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13469 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13470 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13471 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13472 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13473 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013474 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013475 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013476
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013477namespace <name>
13478 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13479 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13480 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13481 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13482
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013483no-agent-check
13484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13486 default value.
13487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13488 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13489
13490no-backup
13491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13493 default value.
13494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13495 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13496
13497no-check
13498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13500 default value.
13501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13502 "default-server" "check" setting.
13503
13504no-check-ssl
13505 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13506 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13507 default value.
13508 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13509 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13510
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013511no-send-proxy
13512 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13513 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13514 default value.
13515 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13516 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13517
13518no-send-proxy-v2
13519 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13520 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13521 default value.
13522 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13523 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13524
13525no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13526 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13527 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13528 default value.
13529 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13530 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13531
13532no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13533 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13534 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13535 default value.
13536 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13537 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13538
13539no-ssl
13540 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13541 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13542 default value.
13543 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13544 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13545
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013546no-ssl-reuse
13547 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13548 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13549 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13550 and for paranoid users.
13551
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013552no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013553 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13554 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013555 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013556
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013557 Supported in default-server: No
13558
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013559no-tls-tickets
13560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13561 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13562 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013563 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13564 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013565 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13566 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13567 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013568 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013569
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013570no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013571 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013572 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13573 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013574 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13575 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013576 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013577
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013578 Supported in default-server: No
13579
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013580no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013581 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013582 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13583 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013584 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13585 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013586 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013587
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013588 Supported in default-server: No
13589
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013590no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013591 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013592 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13593 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013594 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13595 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013596 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013597
13598 Supported in default-server: No
13599
13600no-tlsv13
13601 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13602 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13603 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13604 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13605 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013606 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013607
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013608 Supported in default-server: No
13609
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013610no-verifyhost
13611 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13612 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13613 default value.
13614 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13615 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013616
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013617no-tfo
13618 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13619 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13620 default value.
13621 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13622 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13623
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013624non-stick
13625 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13626 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13627 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13628
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013629npn <protocols>
13630 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13631 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13632 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013633 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013634 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13635 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13636 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13637
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013638observe <mode>
13639 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13640 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13641 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13642 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13643 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13644 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013645 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013646
13647 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013649on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013650 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13651 Currently, four modes are available:
13652 - fastinter: force fastinter
13653 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13654 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13655 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13656 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13657
13658 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13659
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013660on-marked-down <action>
13661 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13662 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013663 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13664 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13665 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13666 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13667 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13668 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13669 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13670 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013671
13672 Actions are disabled by default
13673
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013674on-marked-up <action>
13675 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13676 Currently one action is available:
13677 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13678 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13679 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13680 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013681 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13682 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013683 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13684 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13685
13686 Actions are disabled by default
13687
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013688pool-low-conn <max>
13689 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13690 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13691 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13692 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13693 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13694 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13695 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13696 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13697 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13698 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13699 applying to "http-reuse".
13700
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013701pool-max-conn <max>
13702 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13703 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13704 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13705 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13706 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13707 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13708
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013709pool-purge-delay <delay>
13710 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013711 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013712 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013714port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013715 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13716 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13717 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13718 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13719 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13720 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13721
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013722proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013723 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13724 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13725 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13726 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013727 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013728 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013730redir <prefix>
13731 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13732 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13733 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13734 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13735 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13736 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13737 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13738 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013739 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013740 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013741 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13742 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13743 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13744 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13745
13746 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013748rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013749 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13750 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13751 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13752
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013753resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13754 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13755 server.
13756
13757 Available options:
13758
13759 * allow-dup-ip
13760 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13761 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13762 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13763 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13764 For such case, simply enable this option.
13765 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13766
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013767 * ignore-weight
13768 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13769 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13770 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13771
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013772 * prevent-dup-ip
13773 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13774 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13775 same fqdn.
13776 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13777
13778 Example:
13779 backend b_myapp
13780 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13781 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13782 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13783
13784 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13785 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13786 it
13787 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13788 different address
13789
13790 Default value: not set
13791
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013792resolve-prefer <family>
13793 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13794 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13795 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13796 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13797
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013798 Default value: ipv6
13799
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013800 Example:
13801
13802 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013803
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013804resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013805 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013806 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013807 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13809 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013810 configured network, another address is selected.
13811
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013812 Example:
13813
13814 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013815
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013816resolvers <id>
13817 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13818 hostname.
13819
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013820 Example:
13821
13822 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013823
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013824 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013825
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013826send-proxy
13827 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13828 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13829 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13830 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013831 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13832 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13833 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13834 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13835 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13836 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13837 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13838 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13839 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13840 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013841 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13842 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013843
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013844send-proxy-v2
13845 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13846 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13847 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13848 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013849 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13850 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13851 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13852 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013853
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013854proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013855 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13856 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13857
13858 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13859 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13860 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13861 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13862 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13863 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13864 connection is supported).
13865 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13866 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13867 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13868 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13869 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13870 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13871 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013872
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013873send-proxy-v2-ssl
13874 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13875 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13876 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13877 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13878 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13879 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13880 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013881 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13882 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013883
13884send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13885 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13886 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13887 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13888 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13889 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13890 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13891 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13892 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013893 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13894 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013895
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013896slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013897 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13898 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13899 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13900 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13901 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13902 parameters :
13903
13904 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13905 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13906
13907 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13908 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13909 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13910 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13911
13912 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13913 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13914 seen as failed.
13915
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013916sni <expression>
13917 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13918 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13919 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13920 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013921 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13922 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013923 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013924 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13925 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013926
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013927source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013928source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013929source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013930 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13931 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13932 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13933 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13934
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013935 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13936 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13937 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13938 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13939 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13940 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13941 server.
13942
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013943 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13944 specifying the source address without port(s).
13945
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013946ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013947 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13948 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13949 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13950 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13951 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13952 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013953 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13954 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013955
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013956ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13957 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13958 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13959 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13960
13961ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13962 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13963 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13964 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13965
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013966ssl-reuse
13967 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13968 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13969 default value.
13970 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13971 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13972
13973stick
13974 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13975 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13976 default value.
13977 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13978 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013979
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013980socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013981 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013982 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13983 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13984
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013985tcp-ut <delay>
13986 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13987 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13988 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013989 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013990 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13991 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13992 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13993 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13994 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13995 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13996 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13997 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13998 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13999
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014000tfo
14001 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14002 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14003 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14004 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14005 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014006 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014008track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014009 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14010 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14011 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14012 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014013 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14014
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014015tls-tickets
14016 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14017 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14018 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014019 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14020 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14021 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014022 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014023 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014024
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014025verify [none|required]
14026 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014027 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014028 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14029 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014030 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014031 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14032 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14033 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14034 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14035 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14036 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14037 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14038 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014039
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014040verifyhost <hostname>
14041 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014042 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14043 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14044 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14045 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14046 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14047 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14048 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14049 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014051weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014052 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14053 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14054 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014055 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14056 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14057 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14058 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14059 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14060 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014061
14062
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140635.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14064-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014065
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014066HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14067using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
14068configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014069This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14070can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14071workload.
14072This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14073resolution at run time.
14074Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14075carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14076
14077
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200140785.3.1. Global overview
14079----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014080
14081As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14082different steps of the process life:
14083
14084 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14085 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14086 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14087
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014088 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14089 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014090
14091A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14092 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14093 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14094 resolution to know this new IP.
14095
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014096When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014097HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014098SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14099from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14100will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14101will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014102
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014103A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014104 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014105 first valid response.
14106
14107 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14108 servers return an error.
14109
14110
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200141115.3.2. The resolvers section
14112----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014113
14114This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014115HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14116contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014117
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014118When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14119uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14120is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14121answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14122
14123When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014124used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014125
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014126 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14127 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14128 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014129
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014130 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14131 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014132
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014133 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14134 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14135 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014136
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014137For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14138following scenarios are possible:
14139
14140 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14141 ignored
14142
14143 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14144 applied
14145
14146 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14147 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14148
14149 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14150 retries the query with a new type
14151
14152 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14153 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014154
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014155As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14156a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014157<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014158
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014159
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014160resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014161 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014162
14163A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14164
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014165accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014167 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014168 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14169 by RFC 6891)
14170
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014171 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14172
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014173nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14174 DNS server description:
14175 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14176 <ip> : IP address of the server
14177 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14178
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014179parse-resolv-conf
14180 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14181 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14182 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14183
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014184hold <status> <period>
14185 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14186 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014187 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014188 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014189 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14190 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14191 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14192
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014193 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014194
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014195resolve_retries <nb>
14196 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14197 giving up.
14198 Default value: 3
14199
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014200 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14201 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14202 type.
14203
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014204timeout <event> <time>
14205 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14206 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14207 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014208 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14209 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014210 Default value: 1s
14211 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014212 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014213 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014214 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14215 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14216
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014217 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014218
14219 resolvers mydns
14220 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14221 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014222 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014223 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014224 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014225 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014226 hold other 30s
14227 hold refused 30s
14228 hold nx 30s
14229 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014230 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014231 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014232
14233
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200142346. Cache
14235---------
14236
14237HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14238(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14239RAM.
14240
14241The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14242this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14243
14244If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14245independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14246when we try to allocate a new one.
14247
14248The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14249
14250It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14251"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14252for more details.
14253
14254When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14255replaced by "<CACHE>".
14256
14257
142586.1. Limitation
14259----------------
14260
14261The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14262
14263- If the response is not a 200
14264- If the response contains a Vary header
14265- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14266- If the response is not cacheable
14267
14268- If the request is not a GET
14269- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14270- If the request contains an Authorization header
14271
14272
142736.2. Setup
14274-----------
14275
14276To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14277the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14278
14279
142806.2.1. Cache section
14281---------------------
14282
14283cache <name>
14284 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14285 size of cache is mandatory.
14286
14287total-max-size <megabytes>
14288 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14289 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14290
14291max-object-size <bytes>
14292 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14293 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14294 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14295
14296max-age <seconds>
14297 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14298 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14299 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14300 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14301 default.
14302
14303
143046.2.2. Proxy section
14305---------------------
14306
14307http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14308 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14309 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14310 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14311 after this one.
14312
14313http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14314 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14315 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14316 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14317 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14318
14319
14320Example:
14321
14322 backend bck1
14323 mode http
14324
14325 http-request cache-use foobar
14326 http-response cache-store foobar
14327 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14328
14329 cache foobar
14330 total-max-size 4
14331 max-age 240
14332
14333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143347. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14335----------------------------------
14336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014337HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14339The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14340these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14341but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14342data called patterns.
14343
14344
143457.1. ACL basics
14346---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014347
14348The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14349content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14350from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14351simple :
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014354 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14356 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14359adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014360
14361In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014363 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014364
14365This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14366Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14367and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014368an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14369conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14370as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14371are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014372
14373ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14374'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14375which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14376
14377There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14378performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14381specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14382this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014383methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14384ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385
14386Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14387 - boolean
14388 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14389 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14390 - string
14391 - data block
14392
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014393Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14394converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14395would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14396The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14397which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14398
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014399Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14400keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14401fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14402which are summarized in the table below :
14403
14404 +---------------------+-----------------+
14405 | Sample or converter | Default |
14406 | output type | matching method |
14407 +---------------------+-----------------+
14408 | boolean | bool |
14409 +---------------------+-----------------+
14410 | integer | int |
14411 +---------------------+-----------------+
14412 | ip | ip |
14413 +---------------------+-----------------+
14414 | string | str |
14415 +---------------------+-----------------+
14416 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14417 +---------------------+-----------------+
14418
14419Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14420matching method, see below.
14421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014422The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14423 - boolean
14424 - integer or integer range
14425 - IP address / network
14426 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14427 - regular expression
14428 - hex block
14429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014430The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14431
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014432 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14433 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014435 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014436 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014437 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014438 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014440The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14441read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14442if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14443lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14444will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14445beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14446a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14447lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14448exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14449
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014450The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14451parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14452ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14453a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14454check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14455
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014456The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14457socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14458file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14461loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14462
14463 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14464
14465In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14466the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14467case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14468as well.
14469
14470The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14471sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14472do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14473methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14474is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014475obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14477default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14478that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14479string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14480
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014481The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14482By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14483string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14484resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14485server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014486waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014487flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14488function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14491sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14492be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014493
14494 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14495 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14497 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14498 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14499 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014500
14501 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14502 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014503 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014504
14505 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014507
14508 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014510
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014511 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014512 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14513
14514 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14515 binary or string samples.
14516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14518 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014520 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14521 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14522 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14525 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14528 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14531 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14534 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014535 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14538 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14539 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014540
14541For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14542request, it is possible to do :
14543
14544 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14545
14546In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14547buffer, one would use the following acl :
14548
14549 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14550
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014551On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14552possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14553
14554 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014556All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14557criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14558method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14559to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14560criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14561the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014563If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014564the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14565For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14568 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14569 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14570 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014571
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014572
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014573The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14574types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14575combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14576brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14577default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014579 +-------------------------------------------------+
14580 | Input sample type |
14581 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014582 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14584 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14585 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014586 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014588 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014590 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014592 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014594 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014595 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014596 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014598 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014600 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014602 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014604 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014606 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014607 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14608 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14609 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014610
14611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146127.1.1. Matching booleans
14613------------------------
14614
14615In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14616Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14617When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14618that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14619
14620Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14621return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14622"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14623
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146257.1.2. Matching integers
14626------------------------
14627
14628Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14629enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14630to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14631
14632Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14633matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14634lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014635
14636For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14637unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14638representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14639
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014640As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14641two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14642instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14643ranges and operators.
14644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014645For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014646operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14647Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14648of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014650Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014651
14652 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14653 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14654 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14655 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14656 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014658For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014659
14660 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14661
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014662This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14663
14664 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14665
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200146677.1.3. Matching strings
14668-----------------------
14669
14670String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14671different forms :
14672
14673 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014674 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675
14676 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014677 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678
14679 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14680 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14681
14682 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14683 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14684
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014685 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014686 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14687 matches.
14688
14689 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14690 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14691 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014692
14693String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14694exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14695characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14696string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14697to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014698before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014699
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014700Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14701(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14702Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14703
14704Example:
14705 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14706 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14707
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147097.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14710---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014711
14712Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14713they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14714possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14715passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14716the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014717the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14718match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014719
14720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147217.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14722-------------------------------------
14723
14724It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14725not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14726a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14727to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14728digits may be used upper or lower case.
14729
14730Example :
14731 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14732 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14733
14734
147357.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14736---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014737
14738IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14739netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14740within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014741host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014742difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14743at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14744does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14745parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014746
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014747The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14748abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14749
14750 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14751 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14752 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14753 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14754 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14755 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14756 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14757 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14758
14759Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14760192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14761
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014762IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14763Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14764trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14765IPv6 patterns.
14766
14767HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14768following situations :
14769 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14770 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14771 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14772 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14773 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14774 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14775 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14776 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14777 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14778 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014780
147817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14782----------------------------------
14783
14784Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14785combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14786
14787 - AND (implicit)
14788 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14789 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014791A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14796indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14799"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14800requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14801is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14802
14803 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014804 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14805 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14806 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807
14808To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14809and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14810
14811 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14812 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14813 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14814 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14815
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014816 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014817 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14818 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14819 use_backend www if host_www
14820
14821It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14822expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14823be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14824the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14825
14826 The following rule :
14827
14828 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014829 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830
14831 Can also be written that way :
14832
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014833 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014834
14835It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14836to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14837simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14838sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14839good use is the following :
14840
14841 With named ACLs :
14842
14843 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14844 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14845 monitor fail if site_dead
14846
14847 With anonymous ACLs :
14848
14849 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14850
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014851See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14852keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853
14854
148557.3. Fetching samples
14856---------------------
14857
14858Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14859against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14860sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14861ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14862of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14863available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14864
14865This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14866Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14867compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14868deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14869
14870The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14871matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14872method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14873indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14874
14875As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14876when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14877mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14878the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14879ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14880
14881Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14882multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14883when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014884incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14885are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014886is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14887all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14888
14889Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14890 - name
14891 - name(arg1)
14892 - name(arg1,arg2)
14893
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014894
148957.3.1. Converters
14896-----------------
14897
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014898Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14899of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14900is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14901was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014902has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014903unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14904
14905These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14906sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14907the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014908support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014909
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014910A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14911support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14912supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14913(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14914bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014917
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001491851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14919 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14920 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14921 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14922 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14923 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14924
14925 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014926 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14927 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014928 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14929 frontend http-in
14930 bind *:8081
14931 default_backend servers
14932 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14933 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14934
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014935add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014936 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014937 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014938 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14939 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014940 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014941 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14942 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14943 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14944 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014946 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014947
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014948aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14949 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14950 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14951 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14952 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14953 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14954 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14955
14956 Example:
14957 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14958 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14959
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014960and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014961 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014962 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014963 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14964 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014965 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014966 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14967 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14968 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14969 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014971 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014972
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014973b64dec
14974 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14975 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14976
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014977base64
14978 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014979 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014980 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14981
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014982bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014983 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014984 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014985 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014986 presence of a flag).
14987
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014988bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14989 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14990 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014991 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014992
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014993concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14994 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14995 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14996 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14997 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14998 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14999 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15000 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15001 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15002 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15003 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015004 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015005 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015006 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15007 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015008
15009 Example:
15010 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15011 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15012 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015013 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015014 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15015
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015016cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015017 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15018 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015019
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015020crc32([<avalanche>])
15021 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15022 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15023 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15024 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15025 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15026 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15027 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15028 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15029 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15030 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015031 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15032
15033crc32c([<avalanche>])
15034 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15035 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15036 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15037 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15038 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15039 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15040 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15041 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015042
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015043cut_crlf
15044 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15045 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15046 updated.
15047
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015048da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015049 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15050 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15051 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15052 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015053 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015054 configuration language.
15055
15056 Example:
15057 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015058 bind *:8881
15059 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015060 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015061
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015062debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15063 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15064 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15065 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15066 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15067 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15068 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15069 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15070 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15071 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15072 printable sample types.
15073
15074 Example:
15075 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015076
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015077digest(<algorithm>)
15078 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15079 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15080
15081 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15082 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15083
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015084div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015085 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15086 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015087 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015088 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15089 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015090 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015091 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15092 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15093 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15094 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015096 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015097
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015098djb2([<avalanche>])
15099 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15100 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15101 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15102 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15103 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15104 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15105 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015106 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15107 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015108
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015109even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015110 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015111 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15112
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015113field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15114 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15115 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15116 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15117 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15118 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15119 fields.
15120
15121 Example :
15122 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15123 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15124 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15125 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15126 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015127
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015128hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015129 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015130 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015131 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015132 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015133
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015134hex2i
15135 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015136 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015137
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015138htonl
15139 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15140 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15141 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15142 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15143
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015144hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
15145 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15146 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15147 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15148 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15149
15150 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15151 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15152
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015153http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015154 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15155 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015156 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15157 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15158 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15159 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15160 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15161 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15162 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15163 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015165iif(<true>,<false>)
15166 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15167 string otherwise.
15168
15169 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015170 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015171
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015172in_table(<table>)
15173 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15174 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15175 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015176 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015177 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15178
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015179ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
15180 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015181 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015182 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15183 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15184 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15185 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15186 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015187
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015188json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015189 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015190 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015191 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015192 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15193 of errors:
15194 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15195 bytes, ...)
15196 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15197 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15198
15199 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15200 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15201 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15202 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15203 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15204 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015205 - "ascii" : never fails;
15206 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15207 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015208 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015209 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015210 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15211 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15212
15213 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015214 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015215
15216 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015217 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015218 capture request header user-agent len 150
15219 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015220
15221 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15222 GET / HTTP/1.0
15223 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15224
15225 Output log:
15226 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015228language(<value>[,<default>])
15229 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15230 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15231 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15232 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15233 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15234 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15235 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15236 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15237 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015238 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015239 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15240 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015241
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015242 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015243
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015244 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15245 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015246
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015247 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15248 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15249 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15250 use_backend spanish if es
15251 use_backend french if fr
15252 use_backend english if en
15253 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015254
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015255length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015256 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15257 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15258 type. The result is of type integer.
15259
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015260lower
15261 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15262 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15263 type. The result is of type string.
15264
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015265ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15266 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15267 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15268 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15269 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15270 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15271 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15272
15273 Example :
15274
15275 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015276 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015277 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15278
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015279ltrim(<chars>)
15280 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15281 representation of the input sample.
15282
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015283map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15284map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15285map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15286 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15287 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15288 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15289 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15290 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15291 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15292 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15293 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015294
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015295 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15296 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15297 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015298
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015299 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015300 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015301
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015302 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15303 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15304 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15305 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015306 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15307 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015308 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15309 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15310 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15311 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15312 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15313 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15314 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15315 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015316 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15317 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15318 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015319 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15320 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15321 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15322 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15323 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015324
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015325 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15326 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15327 the corresponding match text.
15328
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015329 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15330 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15331 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15332 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15333 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015335 Example :
15336
15337 # this is a comment and is ignored
15338 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15339 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15340 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15341 | | | `---------- value
15342 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15343 | `---------------------------- key
15344 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15345
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015346mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015347 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15348 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015349 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015350 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15354 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15355 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015356 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015357 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015358
15359mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015360 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015361 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15362 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015372
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015373nbsrv
15374 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15375 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15376 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15377 map lookup.
15378
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015379neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015380 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15381 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15382 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15383 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015384
15385not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015386 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015387 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015388 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015389 absence of a flag).
15390
15391odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015392 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015393 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15394
15395or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015396 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015397 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015398 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15399 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15403 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15404 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015405 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015406 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015407
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015408protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15409 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15410 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15411 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15412 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15413 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15414 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15415 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15416 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15417 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15418 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15419 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15420
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015421regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015422 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15423 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15424 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15425 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15426 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15427 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15428 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15429 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15430 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015431 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15432 of characters with other ones.
15433
15434 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15435 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15436 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15437 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15438 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15439 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015440
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015441 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015442
15443 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15444 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15445 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015446 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015447
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015448 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15449 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15450
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015451 # capture groups and backreferences
15452 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015453 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015454 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15455
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015456capture-req(<id>)
15457 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15458 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15459
15460 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015461 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15462 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015463
15464capture-res(<id>)
15465 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15466 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15467
15468 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015469 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15470 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015471
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015472rtrim(<chars>)
15473 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15474 of the input sample.
15475
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015476sdbm([<avalanche>])
15477 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15478 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15479 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15480 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15481 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15482 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15483 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015484 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15485 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015486
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015487secure_memcmp(<var>)
15488 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15489 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15490 match.
15491
15492 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15493 performed in constant time.
15494
15495 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15496 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15497
15498 Example :
15499
15500 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15501 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15502 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15503 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15504
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015505set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015506 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15507 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15508 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015509 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015510 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15511 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015512 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015513 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15514 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015515 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015516 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015517
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015518sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015519 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015520 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15521
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015522sha2([<bits>])
15523 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15524 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15525
15526 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15527 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15528
15529 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15530 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15531
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015532srv_queue
15533 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15534 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15535 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15536 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15537 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15538
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015539strcmp(<var>)
15540 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15541 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15542 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15543 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15544 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15545 shorter).
15546
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015547 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15548 strings in constant time.
15549
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015550 Example :
15551
15552 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15553 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15554 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15555
15556
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015557sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015558 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15559 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015560 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015561 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15562 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015563 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015564 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15565 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015566 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015567 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15568 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015569 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015570 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015571
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015572table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15573 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15574 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15575 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15576 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15577 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15578 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15579
15580
15581table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15582 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15583 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15584 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15585 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15586 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15587 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15588
15589table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15590 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15591 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015592 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015593 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15594 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15595
15596table_conn_cur(<table>)
15597 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15598 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15599 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15600 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15601 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15602
15603table_conn_rate(<table>)
15604 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15605 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15606 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15607 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15608 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15609
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015610table_gpt0(<table>)
15611 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15612 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15613 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15614 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15615 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15616
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015617table_gpc0(<table>)
15618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15620 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15621 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15622 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15623
15624table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15625 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15626 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15627 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15628 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15629 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15630 sample fetch keyword.
15631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015632table_gpc1(<table>)
15633 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15634 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15635 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15636 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15637 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15638
15639table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15640 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15641 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15642 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15643 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15644 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15645 sample fetch keyword.
15646
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015647table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15648 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15649 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015650 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015651 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15652 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15653
15654table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15655 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15656 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15657 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15658 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15659 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15660 keyword.
15661
15662table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15663 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15664 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015666 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15667 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15668
15669table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15670 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15671 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15672 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15673 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15674 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15675 keyword.
15676
15677table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015681 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15682 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15683 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15684 keyword.
15685
15686table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15687 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15688 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015689 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015690 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15691 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15692 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15693 keyword.
15694
15695table_server_id(<table>)
15696 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15697 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15698 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15699 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15700 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15701 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15702
15703table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15704 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15705 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015706 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015707 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15708 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15709 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15710 keyword.
15711
15712table_sess_rate(<table>)
15713 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15714 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15715 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15716 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15717 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15718 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15719 keyword.
15720
15721table_trackers(<table>)
15722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15725 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15726 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15727 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15728 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15729 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15730 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15731 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15732
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015733upper
15734 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15735 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15736 type. The result is of type string.
15737
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015738url_dec([<in_form>])
15739 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15740 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15741 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15742 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15743 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15744 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015745
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015746ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015747 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015748 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15749 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15750 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015751 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15752 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15753 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15754 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015755 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015756 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15757 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015758
15759 Example:
15760 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15761 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15762
15763 message Point {
15764 int32 latitude = 1;
15765 int32 longitude = 2;
15766 }
15767
15768 message PPoint {
15769 Point point = 59;
15770 }
15771
15772 message Rectangle {
15773 // One corner of the rectangle.
15774 PPoint lo = 48;
15775 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15776 PPoint hi = 49;
15777 }
15778
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015779 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15780 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15781 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015782
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015783 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15784 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015785 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015786 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15787
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015788 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015789
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015790 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015791
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015792 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15793 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15794 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015795
15796 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15797 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15798 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15799
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015800 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15801 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15802 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015803
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015804
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015805unset-var(<var name>)
15806 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15807 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15811 response),
15812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15816
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015817utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15818 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15819 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15820 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15821 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15822 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15823 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15824
15825 Example :
15826
15827 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015828 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015829 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15830
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015831word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15832 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15833 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15834 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015835 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015836 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15837 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15838
15839 Example :
15840 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15841 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15842 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15843 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15844 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015845 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015846
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015847wt6([<avalanche>])
15848 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15849 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15850 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15851 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15852 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15853 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15854 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015855 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15856 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015857
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015858xor(<value>)
15859 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015860 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015861 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015862 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015863 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015864 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15865 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015866 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015867 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15868 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015869 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015870 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015871
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015872xxh32([<seed>])
15873 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15874 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15875 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15876 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15877 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15878 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15879 as cryptographically secure.
15880
15881xxh64([<seed>])
15882 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15883 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15884 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15885 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15886 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15887 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15888 as cryptographically secure.
15889
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015890
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158917.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892--------------------------------------------
15893
15894A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15895not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15896"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15897The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15898
15899always_false : boolean
15900 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15901 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15902
15903always_true : boolean
15904 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15905 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15906
15907avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015908 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015909 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15910 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15911 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15912 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15913 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15914 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15915 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15916 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15917 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15918 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15919 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15920 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15921 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015924 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15925 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15926 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15927 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015928 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15929
15930be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15931 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15932 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15933 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15934 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15935 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015936 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15937 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015938
15939 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15940 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15941 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015943be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15944 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15945 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15946 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15949 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015950
15951 Example :
15952 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15953 backend dynamic
15954 mode http
15955 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15956 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015957
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015958bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015959 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15960 of the string.
15961
15962bool(<bool>) : bool
15963 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15964 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015968 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15970 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015971
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015972 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015973 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015974 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15975
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015976 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15977 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015978
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015979 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015980 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015981 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015982 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015983 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015985 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015986
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015987 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15988 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015990 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015991
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015992cpu_calls : integer
15993 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15994 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15995 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15996 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15997 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15998 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15999
16000cpu_ns_avg : integer
16001 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16002 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16003 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16004 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16005 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16006 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16007 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16008 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16009 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16010 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16011 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16012
16013cpu_ns_tot : integer
16014 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16015 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16016 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16017 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16018 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16019 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16020 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16021 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16022 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16023 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16024 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16025 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16026 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16027
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016028date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016029 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016030
16031 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16032 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16033 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016034 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16035
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016036 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16037 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16038 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16039 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16040 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16041
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016042 Example :
16043
16044 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16045 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016046
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016047 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16048 # millisecond granularity
16049 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16050
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016051date_us : integer
16052 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16053 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16054 from the same timeval structure.
16055
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016056distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16057 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16058 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16059 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16060 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16061 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16062 list of supported tokens.
16063
16064distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16065 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16066 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16067 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16068 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16069 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16070 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16071 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16072 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16073 supported tokens.
16074
16075 Example :
16076 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16077 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16078 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16079 # send large files to the big farm
16080 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16081
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016082env(<name>) : string
16083 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16084 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16085 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16086 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16087 certain way.
16088
16089 Examples :
16090 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16091 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16092
16093 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16094 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16097 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016098 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16099 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16101 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016102 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16104 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016105
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016106fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16107 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16108 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16109 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16113 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16114 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16115 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16116 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16117 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16118 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16119 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016120
16121 Example :
16122 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16123 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16124 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16125 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16126 frontend mail
16127 bind :25
16128 mode tcp
16129 maxconn 100
16130 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16131 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16132 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16133 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016134
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016135hostname : string
16136 Returns the system hostname.
16137
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016138int(<integer>) : signed integer
16139 Returns a signed integer.
16140
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016141ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16142 Returns an ipv4.
16143
16144ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16145 Returns an ipv6.
16146
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016147lat_ns_avg : integer
16148 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16149 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16150 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16151 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16152 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16153 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16154 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16155 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16156 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016157 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16158 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16159 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16160 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16161 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16162 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016163
16164lat_ns_tot : integer
16165 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16166 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16167 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16168 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16169 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16170 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16171 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16172 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16173 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016174 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16175 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16176 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16177 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16178 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016179 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16180 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16181 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16182 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16183 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16184 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16185
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016186meth(<method>) : method
16187 Returns a method.
16188
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016189nbproc : integer
16190 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16191 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16192 and debugging purposes.
16193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16196 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16197 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016198 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16199 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16200 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016201
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016202prio_class : integer
16203 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16204 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16205 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16206
16207prio_offset : integer
16208 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16209 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16210 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16211 set-priority-offset".
16212
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016213proc : integer
16214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16215 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16216 debugging purposes.
16217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016219 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16220 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16221 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016222 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16223 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16224 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16225 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16226 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16227
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016228rand([<range>]) : integer
16229 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16230 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16231 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16232 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16233 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16234
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016235uuid([<version>]) : string
16236 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16237 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16238 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16242 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16243 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16244 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16245 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016246 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16247 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16248
16249srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16251 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16252 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16253 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16254 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16255 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16256 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16257
16258 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16259 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260
16261srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16262 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16263 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16264 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016265 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16267 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16268 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16269
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016270srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16272 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16273 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16274 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16275 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16276 fetch methods.
16277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16279 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16280 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016281 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016282 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16283 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016284 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285 overloading servers).
16286
16287 Example :
16288 # Redirect to a separate back
16289 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16290 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16291 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16292
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016293srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16294 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16295 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16296 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16297
16298srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16299 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16300 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16301 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16302
16303srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16304 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16305 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16306 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16307
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016308stopping : boolean
16309 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16310 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16311 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16312
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016313str(<string>) : string
16314 Returns a string.
16315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016316table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16317 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16318 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16319
16320table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16321 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16322 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16323 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16324
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016325thread : integer
16326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16327 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16328 and debugging purposes.
16329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016330var(<var-name>) : undefined
16331 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016332 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16333 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016334 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016337 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016338 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16339 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016340 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016341 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344----------------------------------
16345
16346The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16347closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16348methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16349sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16350TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016351the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16352counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016353"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16354used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16355can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16356Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16357table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16358tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16359currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016360
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016361bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016362 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16363 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16364 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016366be_id : integer
16367 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016368 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16369 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016371be_name : string
16372 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016373 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16374 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376dst : ip
16377 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16378 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16379 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16380 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016381 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16382 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16383 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16384 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16385 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16386 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387
16388dst_conn : integer
16389 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16390 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16391 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16392 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16393 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16394 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16395 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16396 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016397
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016398dst_is_local : boolean
16399 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16400 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16401 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16402 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016403 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016404 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16405 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16406 it only once per connection.
16407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016408dst_port : integer
16409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16410 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16411 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16412 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16413 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16414 an HTTP header.
16415
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016416fc_http_major : integer
16417 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16418 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16419 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16420
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016421fc_pp_authority : string
16422 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16423 if any.
16424
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016425fc_pp_unique_id : string
16426 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16427 if any.
16428
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016429fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16430 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16431 header.
16432
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016433fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16434 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16435 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16436 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16437 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16438 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16439 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16440
16441fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16442 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16443 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16444 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16445 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16446 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16447 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16448
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016449fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016450 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16451 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16452 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16453 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16454
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016455fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016456 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16457 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16458 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16459 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16460
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016461fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016462 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16463 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16464 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16465 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16466
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016467fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016468 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16469 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16470 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16471 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16472
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016473fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016474 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16475 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16476 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16477 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16478
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016479fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016480 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16481 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16482 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16483 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16484
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016485fe_defbe : string
16486 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16487 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016489fe_id : integer
16490 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016491 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16493
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016494fe_name : string
16495 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16496 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16497 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016499sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016500sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16501sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16502sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016503 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16504 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16505 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016507sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016508sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16509sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16510sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016511 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16512 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16513 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016515sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016516sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16517sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16518sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016519 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16520 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016521 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16522 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16523 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016524
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016525 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016526 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16527 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016528 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16529 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16530 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016531 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16532 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16533
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016534sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16535sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16536sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16537sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16538 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16539 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16540 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16541 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16542 when a first ACL was verified.
16543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016544sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016545sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16546sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16547sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016549 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16550
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016551sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016552sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16553sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16554sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016555 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16556 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16557 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16558
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016559sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016560sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16561sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16562sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016563 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16564 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16565 See also src_conn_rate.
16566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016567sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016568sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16569sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16570sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016571 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016572 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016573
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016574sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16575sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16576sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16577sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16578 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16579 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16580
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016581sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16582sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16583sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16584sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16585 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16586 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16587
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016588sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016589sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16590sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16591sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016592 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16593 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16594 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016595 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16596 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16597 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016598
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016599sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16600sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16601sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16602sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16603 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16604 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16605 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16606 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16607 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16608 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016610sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016611sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16612sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16613sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016615 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16616 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016618sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016619sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16620sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16621sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016622 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16623 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16624 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16625 src_http_err_rate.
16626
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016627sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016628sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16629sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16630sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016631 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016632 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16633 src_http_req_cnt.
16634
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016635sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016636sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16637sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16638sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016639 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16640 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16641 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16642 src_http_req_rate.
16643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016644sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016645sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16646sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16647sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016648 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016649 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16650 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16651 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16652 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016653
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016654 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016655 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16656 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016657 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16658
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016659sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16660sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16661sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16662sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16663 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16664 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16665 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16666 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16667 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016669sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016670sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16671sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16672sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016673 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16674 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16675 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016676
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016677sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016678sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16679sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16680sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016681 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16682 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16683 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016684
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016685sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016686sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16687sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16688sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016689 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016690 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16691 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16692 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016693 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016694 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016696sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016697sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16698sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16699sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016700 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16701 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16702 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16703 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16704 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016705 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016707sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016708sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16709sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16710sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016711 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16712 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16713 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016715sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016716sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16717sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16718sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016719 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16720 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016721 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016722 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16723 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016724 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16725 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16726 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728so_id : integer
16729 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16730 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16731 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016732
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016733so_name : string
16734 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16735 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16736 strings instead of integers.
16737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016738src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016739 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16741 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16742 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016743 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16744 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16745 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016746 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16747 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16748 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16749 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16750 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16751 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16752 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016753
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016754 Example:
16755 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16756 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016758src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16759 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16760 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16761 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016762 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16765 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16766 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016767 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016768 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16771 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16772 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16773 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16774 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16775 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16776 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016777
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016778 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016779 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16780 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16781 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16782 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016783 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016784 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16785 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16786
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016787src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16788 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16789 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16790 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16791 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16792 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16793 was verified.
16794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016795src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016796 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016797 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016798 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016799 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016802 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016803 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16804 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016805 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16808 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16809 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16810 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016811 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016814 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016816 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016817 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016818
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016819src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16820 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16821 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16822 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16823 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16824
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016825src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16826 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16827 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16828 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16829 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016832 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016833 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016834 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16835 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016836 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16837 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16838 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016839
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016840src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16841 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16842 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16843 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16844 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16845 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16846 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16847 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016849src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016850 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016852 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016853 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16857 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16858 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16859 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16860 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016861 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016864 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16866 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016867 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016869src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16870 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16871 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16872 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016873 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016874 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016876src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16877 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16878 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16879 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016880 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16882 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016883
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016884 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016885 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016886 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016887 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016888
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016889src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16890 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16891 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16892 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16893 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16894 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16895 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16896
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016897src_is_local : boolean
16898 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16899 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16900 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16901 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016902 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016903 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16904 once per connection.
16905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016907 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16908 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16909 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16910 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16911 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016913src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016914 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16915 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16916 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16917 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16918 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920src_port : integer
16921 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16922 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16923 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16924 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016926src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016927 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016928 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16929 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16930 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016931 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016933src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16934 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16935 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16936 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16937 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016938 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016940src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16941 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16942 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16943 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16944 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16945 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16946 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16947 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16948 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016949
16950 Example :
16951 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16952 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16953 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16954 listen ssh
16955 bind :22
16956 mode tcp
16957 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016958 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016959 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016960 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016962srv_id : integer
16963 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16964 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016965 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016966
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016967srv_name : string
16968 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16969 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016970 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016971
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016973----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16976closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16977when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16978usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016979future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016980
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001698151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16982 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16983 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16984 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16985 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16986 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16987
16988 Example :
16989 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16990 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16991 # the request.
16992 frontend http-in
16993 bind *:8081
16994 default_backend servers
16995 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16996 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16997
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016998ssl_bc : boolean
16999 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17000 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017001 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17002 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017003
17004ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17005 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017006 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17007 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017008
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017009ssl_bc_alpn : string
17010 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17011 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017012 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017013 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17014 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17015 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17016 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17017 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017018 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17019 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017020
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017021ssl_bc_cipher : string
17022 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017023 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17024 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017025
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017026ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17027 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17028 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17029 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017030 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017031
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017032ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17033 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17034 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017035 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17036 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017037
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017038ssl_bc_npn : string
17039 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17040 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017041 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017042 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17043 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17044 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17045 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017046 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17047 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017048
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017049ssl_bc_protocol : string
17050 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017051 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17052 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017053
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017054ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017055 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017056 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017057 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17058 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017059
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017060ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17061 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17062 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17063 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017064 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017065
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017066ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17067 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17068 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017069 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17070 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017071
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017072ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17073 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17074 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17075 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017076 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017077
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017078ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17079 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017080 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17081 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017083ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17084 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17085 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17086 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17087 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17088 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17091 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17092 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17093 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17094 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017095
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017096ssl_c_der : binary
17097 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17098 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17099 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17100
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017101ssl_c_der_chain : binary
17102 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17103 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17104 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17105 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17106 does not support resumed sessions.
17107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108ssl_c_err : integer
17109 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17110 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17111 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17112 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17113 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017114
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017115ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017116 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17117 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17118 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17119 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17120 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17121 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17122 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17123 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017124 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17125 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17126 LDAP v3.
17127 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17128 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017130ssl_c_key_alg : string
17131 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17132 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17133 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135ssl_c_notafter : string
17136 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17137 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17138 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140ssl_c_notbefore : string
17141 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17142 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17143 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017144
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017145ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017146 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17147 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17148 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17149 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17150 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17151 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17152 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17153 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017154 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17155 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17156 LDAP v3.
17157 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17158 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017160ssl_c_serial : binary
17161 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17162 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17163 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017165ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17166 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17167 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17168 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017169 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17170 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17171
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017172 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017173 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17176 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17177 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17178 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017180ssl_c_used : boolean
17181 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17182 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184ssl_c_verify : integer
17185 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17186 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17187 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17188 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017190ssl_c_version : integer
17191 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17192 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017193
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017194ssl_f_der : binary
17195 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17196 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17197 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17198
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017199ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17201 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17202 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17203 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017204 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17206 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17207 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017208 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17209 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17210 LDAP v3.
17211 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17212 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017214ssl_f_key_alg : string
17215 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17216 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17217 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219ssl_f_notafter : string
17220 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17221 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17222 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017224ssl_f_notbefore : string
17225 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17226 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17227 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017228
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017229ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017230 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17231 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17232 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17233 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17234 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17235 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17236 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17237 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017238 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17239 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17240 LDAP v3.
17241 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17242 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244ssl_f_serial : binary
17245 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17246 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17247 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017248
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017249ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17250 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17251 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17252 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17255 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17256 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17257 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259ssl_f_version : integer
17260 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17261 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17262
17263ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017264 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17265 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17266 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268 Example :
17269 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17270 listen http-https
17271 bind :80
17272 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17273 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17274
17275ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17276 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17277 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17278
17279ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017280 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17282 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17283 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17284 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17285 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17286 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17287 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17288 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290ssl_fc_cipher : string
17291 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17292 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017293
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017294ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17295 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17296 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017297 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017298
17299ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17300 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17301 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017302 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017303
17304ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17305 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17306 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17307 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017308 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017309 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017310
17311ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17312 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17313 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017314 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017315
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017316ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17317 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17318 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17319 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17320
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017321ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17322 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17323 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17324 transport layer.
17325 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17326 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17327 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17328 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17329
17330ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17331 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17332 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17333 transport layer.
17334 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17335 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17336 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17337 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17338
17339ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17340 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17341 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17342 transport layer.
17343 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17344 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17345 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17346 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17347
17348ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17349 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17350 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17351 transport layer.
17352 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17353 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17354 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17355 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17356
17357ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17358 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17359 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17360 transport layer.
17361 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17362 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17363 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17364 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017366ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017367 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17368 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017369 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17370 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17371 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17372 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017373
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017374ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17375 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17376 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17377 wait until the handshake happened.
17378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017379ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17380 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017381 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17382 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017383 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017384 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017385
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017386ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017387 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017388 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17389 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017391ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017392 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17394 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17395 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17396 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17397 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17398 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17399 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401ssl_fc_protocol : string
17402 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17403 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017404
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017405ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017406 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017407 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17408 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017409
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017410ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17411 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17412 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17413 transport layer.
17414 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17415 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17416 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17417 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17418
17419ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
17420 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17421 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17422 transport layer.
17423 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17424 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17425 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17426 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17427
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017428ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17429 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17430 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17431 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017433ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17434 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17435 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17436 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17437 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017438
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017439ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17440 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17441 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17442 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17443 BoringSSL.
17444
17445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446ssl_fc_sni : string
17447 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17448 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17449 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17450 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17451 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17452
17453 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17454 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17455 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017456 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017457 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017459 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017460 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17461 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17464 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17465 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017466
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017467ssl_s_der : binary
17468 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17469 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17470 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17471
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017472ssl_s_chain_der : binary
17473 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
17474 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17475 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
17476 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currentlly
17477 does not support resumed sessions.
17478
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017479ssl_s_key_alg : string
17480 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17481 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17482 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17483
17484ssl_s_notafter : string
17485 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17486 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17487 transport layer.
17488
17489ssl_s_notbefore : string
17490 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17491 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17492 transport layer.
17493
17494ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17495 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17496 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17497 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17498 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17499 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17500 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017501 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17502 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017503 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17504 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17505 LDAP v3.
17506 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17507 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17508
17509ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17510 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17511 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17512 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17513 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17514 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17515 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017516 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17517 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017518 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17519 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17520 LDAP v3.
17521 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17522 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17523
17524ssl_s_serial : binary
17525 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17526 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17527 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17528
17529ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17530 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17531 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17532 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17533
17534ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17535 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17536 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17537 layer.
17538
17539ssl_s_version : integer
17540 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17541 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017542
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175437.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017544------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17547sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17548only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17549For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17550be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17551can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17552sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17553for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17554content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017557 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17559 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17562 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017563 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017564 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017565
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017566req.hdrs : string
17567 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17568 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17569 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17570 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17571
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017572req.hdrs_bin : binary
17573 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17574 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17575 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17576 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17577 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17578 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17579
17580 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17581
17582 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17583 str: <int:length><bytes>
17584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017585req.len : integer
17586req_len : integer (deprecated)
17587 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17588 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17589 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17590 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17591 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17592 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17593 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17594 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17597 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017598 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17599 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17600 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17601 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603 ACL alternatives :
17604 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17607 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17608 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17609 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17610 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612 ACL alternatives :
17613 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617req.proto_http : boolean
17618req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17619 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17620 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17621 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17622 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17623 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17624 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17625 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627 Example:
17628 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17629 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17630 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017631 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17634rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17635 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17636 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17637 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17638 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17639 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17640 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17641 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017643 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17644 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17645 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17646 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17647 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17648 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017650 ACL derivatives :
17651 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017653 Example :
17654 listen tse-farm
17655 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17656 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17657 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17658 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17659 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17660 persist rdp-cookie
17661 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17662 # This is only useful makes sense if
17663 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17664 stick-table type string size 204800
17665 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17666 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17667 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017669 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17670 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17673rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17674 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17675 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17676 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17677 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017679 ACL derivatives :
17680 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017681
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017682req.ssl_alpn : string
17683 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17684 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17685 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17686 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17687 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17688 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017689 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017690
17691 Examples :
17692 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17693 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17694 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017695 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017696 default_backend bk_default
17697
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017698req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17699 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17700 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017701 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17702 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17703 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17704 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17705 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017707req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17708req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17709 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17710 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17711 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17712 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17713 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17714 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17715 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017717req.ssl_sni : string
17718req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17719 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17720 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17721 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17722 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17723 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020017724 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
17725 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
17726 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
17727 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
17728 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
17729 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
17730 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
17731 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
17732 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734 ACL derivatives :
17735 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737 Examples :
17738 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17739 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17740 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17741 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17742 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017743
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017744req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17745 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17746 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17747 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17748 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17749 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17750 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17751 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17752 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17753 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755req.ssl_ver : integer
17756req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17757 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17758 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17759 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17760 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17761 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17762 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17763 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017764 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017765 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767 ACL derivatives :
17768 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017769
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017770res.len : integer
17771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17772 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17773 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17774 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17775 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17776 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17777 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017778 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017780res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17781 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017782 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017783 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017784 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017785 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17788 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17789 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17790 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017791 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17792 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017794 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017795
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017796res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17797rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17798 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17799 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17800 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17801 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17802 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17803 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17804 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017806wait_end : boolean
17807 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17808 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017809 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17811 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017812 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17814 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816 Examples :
17817 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17818 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17819 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17822 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17823 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17824 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17825 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17826 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17827 tcp-request content reject
17828
17829
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200178307.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831--------------------------------------
17832
17833It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17834This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17835data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17836its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17837HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17838content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17839to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17840more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17841response are indexed.
17842
17843base : string
17844 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17845 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17846 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17847 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17848 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17849 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17850 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17851 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17852
17853 ACL derivatives :
17854 base : exact string match
17855 base_beg : prefix match
17856 base_dir : subdir match
17857 base_dom : domain match
17858 base_end : suffix match
17859 base_len : length match
17860 base_reg : regex match
17861 base_sub : substring match
17862
17863base32 : integer
17864 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17865 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17866 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017867 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17868 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17869 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017870
17871base32+src : binary
17872 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17873 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17874 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17875 per-URL counters.
17876
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017877capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17878 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17879 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17880 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17881
17882capture.req.method : string
17883 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17884 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17885 because it's allocated.
17886
17887capture.req.uri : string
17888 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17889 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17890 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17891 allocated.
17892
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017893capture.req.ver : string
17894 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17895 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17896 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17897
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017898capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17899 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17900 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17901 The first entry is an index of 0.
17902 See also: "capture response header"
17903
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017904capture.res.ver : string
17905 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17906 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17907 persistent flag.
17908
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017909req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017910 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17911 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17912 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017913
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017914req.body_param([<name>) : string
17915 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17916 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17917 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17918 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17919 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17920 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17921 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17922 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17923 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17924 given.
17925
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017926req.body_len : integer
17927 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17928 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017929 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17930 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017931
17932req.body_size : integer
17933 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017934 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17935 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937req.cook([<name>]) : string
17938cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17939 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17940 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17941 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17942 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17943 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17944 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17945 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17946 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17947
17948 ACL derivatives :
17949 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17950 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17951 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17952 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17953 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17954 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17955 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17956 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17959cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17960 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17961 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17964cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17965 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17966 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17967 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17968 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017970cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17971 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17972 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17973 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17974 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017975 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017976 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17977 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17978 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17979 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017981hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17982 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17983 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17984 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17985 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017986 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017988req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17989 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17990 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17991 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17992 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17993 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17994 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17995 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17996 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017998req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17999 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18000 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18001 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18002 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018004req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18005 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
18006 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
18007 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18008 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18009 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18010 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
18011 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
18012 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000018013 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018015 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018017 ACL derivatives :
18018 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18019 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18020 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18021 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18022 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18023 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18024 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18025 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18026
18027req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18028hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18029 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18030 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
18031 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
18032 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
18033 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
18034 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
18035 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
18036 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
18037 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
18038
18039req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18040hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18041 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18042 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18043 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
18044 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18045 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018046 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
18048 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
18049
18050req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18051hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18052 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18053 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18054 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
18055 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18056 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18057 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
18058 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
18059
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018060
18061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018062http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18063 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18064 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18065 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18066 basic auth is supported.
18067
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018068http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18069 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18070 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18071 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18072 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018073 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18074 basic auth is supported.
18075
18076 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018077 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18078 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18079 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18080 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018082http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018083 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18084 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18085 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018086
18087http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018088 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18089 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18090 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018091
18092http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018093 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18094 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18095 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018098 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18099 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18101 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018103method : integer + string
18104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18105 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18106 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18107 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18108 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18109 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18110 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018112 ACL derivatives :
18113 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115 Example :
18116 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18117 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18118 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018120path : string
18121 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18122 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18123 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18124 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18125 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018126 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018127 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129 ACL derivatives :
18130 path : exact string match
18131 path_beg : prefix match
18132 path_dir : subdir match
18133 path_dom : domain match
18134 path_end : suffix match
18135 path_len : length match
18136 path_reg : regex match
18137 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018138
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018139pathq : string
18140 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18141 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18142 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18143 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18144 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18145 result in both cases.
18146
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018147query : string
18148 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18149 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18150 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18151 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018152 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018153 which stops before the question mark.
18154
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018155req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18156 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18157 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18158 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18159 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161req.ver : string
18162req_ver : string (deprecated)
18163 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18164 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18165 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167 ACL derivatives :
18168 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018169
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018170res.body : binary
18171 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18172 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18173 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18174 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18175
18176res.body_len : integer
18177 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18178 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
18179 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
18180 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
18181
18182res.body_size : integer
18183 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18184 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18185 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18186 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
18187 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
18188 based expect rules.
18189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190res.comp : boolean
18191 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18192 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18193 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018195res.comp_algo : string
18196 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18197 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18198 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200res.cook([<name>]) : string
18201scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18202 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18203 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018204 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
18205 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018207 ACL derivatives :
18208 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18211scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18212 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18213 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018214 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
18215 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18218scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18219 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18220 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018221 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
18222 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018224res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18225 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18226 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18227 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18228 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18229 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
18230 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
18231 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
18232 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018233 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18236 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18237 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18238 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
18239 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018240 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
18241 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18244shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
18245 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
18246 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
18247 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
18248 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
18249 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
18250 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
18251 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018252 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
18253 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 ACL derivatives :
18256 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18257 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18258 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18259 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18260 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18261 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18262 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18263 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18264
18265res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18266shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18267 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
18268 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
18269 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
18270 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018271 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18274shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18275 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
18276 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
18277 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
18278 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
18279 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018280 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
18281 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018282
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018283res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18284 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18285 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18286 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018287 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
18288 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018290res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18291shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18292 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
18293 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
18294 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
18295 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
18296 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018297 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
18298 based expect rules.
18299
18300res.hdrs : string
18301 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18302 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18303 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18304 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
18305 based expect rules.
18306
18307res.hdrs_bin : binary
18308 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18309 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18310 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18311 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18312 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18313 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18314 (length of 0 for both).
18315
18316 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18317
18318 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18319 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018321res.ver : string
18322resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18323 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018324 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
18325 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018327 ACL derivatives :
18328 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018330set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18331 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18332 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018333 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018334 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18337 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339status : integer
18340 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18341 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018342 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
18343 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018344
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018345unique-id : string
18346 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18347 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18348 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18349 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
18350 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
18351 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
18352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018353url : string
18354 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
18355 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
18356 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
18357 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
18358 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
18359 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
18360 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018362 ACL derivatives :
18363 url : exact string match
18364 url_beg : prefix match
18365 url_dir : subdir match
18366 url_dom : domain match
18367 url_end : suffix match
18368 url_len : length match
18369 url_reg : regex match
18370 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372url_ip : ip
18373 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
18374 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
18375 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
18376 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
18377 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
18378 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18379 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381url_port : integer
18382 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
18383 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
18384 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
18385 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018386
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018387urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
18388url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18390 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018391 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18392 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18393 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18394 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018395 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18396 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018397 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18398 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400 ACL derivatives :
18401 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18402 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18403 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18404 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18405 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18406 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18407 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18408 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018409
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018411 Example :
18412 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18413 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18414 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18415 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018416
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018417urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18419 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18420 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018421
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018422url32 : integer
18423 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18424 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18425 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18426 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18427 is an unsigned integer.
18428
18429url32+src : binary
18430 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18431 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18432 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18433
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018434
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200184357.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018436---------------------------------------
18437
18438This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18439used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18440purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18441There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18442or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18443any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18444for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18445
18446internal.htx.data : integer
18447 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18448 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18449
18450internal.htx.free : integer
18451 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18452 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18453
18454internal.htx.free_data : integer
18455 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18456 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18457
18458internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18459 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18460 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18461 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18462
18463internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18464 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18465 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18466
18467internal.htx.size : integer
18468 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18469 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18470
18471internal.htx.used : integer
18472 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18473 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18474 direction.
18475
18476internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18477 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18478 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18479 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18480 of the special value :
18481 * head : The oldest inserted block
18482 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018483 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018484
18485internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18486 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18487 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18488 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18489 integer or one of the special value :
18490 * head : The oldest inserted block
18491 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018492 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018493
18494internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18495 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18496 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18497 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18498 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18499
18500 * head : The oldest inserted block
18501 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018502 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018503
18504internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18505 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18506 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18507 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18508 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18509
18510 * head : The oldest inserted block
18511 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018512 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018513
18514internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18515 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18516 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18517 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18518 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18519
18520 * head : The oldest inserted block
18521 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018522 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018523
18524internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18525 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18526 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18527 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18528 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18529
18530 * head : The oldest inserted block
18531 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018532 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018533
18534internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18535 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18536 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18537 it returns false.
18538
18539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200185407.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018541---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018543Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18544every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018545order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018547ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18548---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018549FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018550HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018551HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18552HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018553HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18554HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18555HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18556HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18557LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018558METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018559METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018560METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18561METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18562METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18563METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018564METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018565METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018566RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018567REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018568TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018569WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18570---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018571
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018572
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185738. Logging
18574----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018575
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018576One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18577provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18578very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18579provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18580state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018581to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018582headers.
18583
18584In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18585about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18586send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18587
18588 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18589 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18590 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18591 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18592 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018593 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018594 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018595
18596The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18597allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18598as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18599while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18600real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18601delay.
18602
18603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186048.1. Log levels
18605---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018606
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018607TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018608source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018609HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18610in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18611track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18612syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18613about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018614
18615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186168.2. Log formats
18617----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018618
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018619HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018620and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18621slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18622options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018623
18624 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18625 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18626 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18627 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18628 extents.
18629
18630 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18631 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18632 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18633 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18634 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18635
18636 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18637 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18638 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18639 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18640 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18641
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018642 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18643 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18644 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18645 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18646
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018647 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18648
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018649Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18650specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18651field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18652servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18653always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18654identifier.
18655
18656Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18657 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18658 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18659 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18660 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18661
18662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186638.2.1. Default log format
18664-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018665
18666This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18667as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18668format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18669
18670 Example :
18671 listen www
18672 mode http
18673 log global
18674 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18675
18676 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18677 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18678 (www/HTTP)
18679
18680 Field Format Extract from the example above
18681 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18682 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18683 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18684 4 'to' to
18685 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18686 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18687
18688Detailed fields description :
18689 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18690 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18691 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18692 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18693 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18694 and processed the connection.
18695 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18696
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018697In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18698"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18699connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18700
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018701It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18702will eventually disappear.
18703
18704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187058.2.2. TCP log format
18706---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707
18708The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18709is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18710information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18711counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18712emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18713environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18714the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18715sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018716specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18717not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18718fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18719marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018720
18721 Example :
18722 frontend fnt
18723 mode tcp
18724 option tcplog
18725 log global
18726 default_backend bck
18727
18728 backend bck
18729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18730
18731 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18732 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18733 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18734
18735 Field Format Extract from the example above
18736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18737 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18738 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18739 4 frontend_name fnt
18740 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18741 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18742 7 bytes_read* 212
18743 8 termination_state --
18744 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18745 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18746
18747Detailed fields description :
18748 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018749 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18750 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18751 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018752 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018753 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018754 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018755
18756 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018757 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18758 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18759 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018760
18761 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18762 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18763 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018764 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18765 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18766 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18767 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018768
18769 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18770 and processed the connection.
18771
18772 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18773 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18774 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18775 applications.
18776
18777 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18778 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18779 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18780 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18781 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18782
18783 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18784 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18785 See "Timers" below for more details.
18786
18787 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18788 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18789 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18790 "Timers" below for more details.
18791
18792 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018793 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018794 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18795 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18796 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18797 details.
18798
18799 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18800 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18801 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18802 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18803 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18804
18805 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18806 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18807 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18808 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18809 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18810 for more details.
18811
18812 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018813 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018814 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18815 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18816 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018817 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018818
18819 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18820 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18821 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18822 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18823 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18824 caused by a denial of service attack.
18825
18826 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18827 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18828 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18829 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18830 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18831 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18832 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18833 denial of service attack.
18834
18835 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18836 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18837 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18838 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18839 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18840 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18841 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18842 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18843 be processed than on other servers.
18844
18845 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18846 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18847 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18848 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18849 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18850 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18851 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18852 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18853 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18854 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18855 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18856 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18857 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18858
18859 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18860 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18861 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18862 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18863 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18864 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018865 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018866 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18867
18868 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18869 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18870 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18871 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18872 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18873 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018874 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018875 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18876 occurs.
18877
18878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188798.2.3. HTTP log format
18880----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018881
18882The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18883is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18884the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18885are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18886emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18887generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18888"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18889which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018890frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18891is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018892
18893Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18894slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18895with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18896
18897 Example :
18898 frontend http-in
18899 mode http
18900 option httplog
18901 log global
18902 default_backend bck
18903
18904 backend static
18905 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18906
18907 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18908 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18909 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018910 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018911
18912 Field Format Extract from the example above
18913 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18914 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018915 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018916 4 frontend_name http-in
18917 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018918 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018919 7 status_code 200
18920 8 bytes_read* 2750
18921 9 captured_request_cookie -
18922 10 captured_response_cookie -
18923 11 termination_state ----
18924 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18925 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18926 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18927 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18928 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018929
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018930Detailed fields description :
18931 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018932 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18933 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18934 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018935 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018936 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018937 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018938
18939 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018940 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18941 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18942 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018943
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018944 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18945 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018946
18947 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18948 and processed the connection.
18949
18950 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18951 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18952 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18953
18954 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18955 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18956 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18957 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18958 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18959 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018961 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18962 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18963 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018964 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018965 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18966 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018967 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18968 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018969
18970 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18971 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018972 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018973
18974 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18975 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018976 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18977 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018978
18979 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18980 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18981 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18982 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18983 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018984 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18985 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018986
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018987 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18988 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18989 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18990 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18991 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18992 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18993 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018994 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018995
18996 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18997 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18998 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18999
19000 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19001 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019002 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019003 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19004 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19005 overflowing.
19006
19007 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19008 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19009 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19010 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19011 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19012 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19013 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19014 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19015
19016 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19017 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19018 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19019 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19020 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19021 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19022 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19023 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19024
19025 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19026 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19027 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19028 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19029 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19030 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19031 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19032
19033 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019034 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019035 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19036 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19037 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019038 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019039 system.
19040
19041 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19042 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19043 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19044 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19045 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19046 caused by a denial of service attack.
19047
19048 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19049 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19050 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19051 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19052 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19053 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19054 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19055 denial of service attack.
19056
19057 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19058 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19059 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19060 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19061 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19062 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19063 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19064 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19065 processed than on other servers.
19066
19067 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19068 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19069 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19070 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19071 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19072 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19073 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19074 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19075 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19076 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19077 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19078 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19079 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19080
19081 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19082 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19083 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19084 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19085 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19086 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019087 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019088 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19089
19090 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19091 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19092 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19093 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19094 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19095 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019096 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019097 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19098 occurs.
19099
19100 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19101 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19102 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19103 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19104 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19105 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19106 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19107 cookies" below for more details.
19108
19109 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19110 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19111 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19112 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19113 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19114 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19115 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19116 and cookies" below for more details.
19117
19118 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19119 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19120 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19121 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19122 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19123 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19124 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19125 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19126
19127
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200191288.2.4. Custom log format
19129------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019130
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019131The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019132mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019133
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019134HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019135Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19136separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19137prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19138
19139Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19140variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019141("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019142
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019143If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019144as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019145less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19146the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19147
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019148Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19149"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19150delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19151preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019152
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019153Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19154'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19155https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19156such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19157
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019158Flags are :
19159 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019160 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019161 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19162 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019163
19164 Example:
19165
19166 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19167 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19168
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019169 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19170
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019171At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19172
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019173 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19174 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019175
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019176the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019178 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19179 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19180 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019181
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019182and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19183
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019184 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19185 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019186
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019187Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19188
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019189 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019190 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019191 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19192 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19193 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019194 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19195 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19196 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019197 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019198 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
19199 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019200 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019201 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19202 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019203 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019204 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019205 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019206 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019207 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019208 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019209 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019210 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19211 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19212 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19213 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19214 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019215 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019216 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019217 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019218 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019219 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019220 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19221 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019222 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19223 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19224 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019225 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019226 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19227 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019228 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019229 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19230 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19231 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019232 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019233 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019234 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19235 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19236 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19237 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019238 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019239 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019240 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019241 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019242 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019243 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019244 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19245 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19246 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019247 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019248 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19249 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019250 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019251 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19252 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019253 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019254 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019255 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019256 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019257
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019258 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019259
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019260
192618.2.5. Error log format
19262-----------------------
19263
19264When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19265protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19266By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19267"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019268will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019269logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19270
19271The format looks like this :
19272
19273 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19274 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19275 Connection error during SSL handshake
19276
19277 Field Format Extract from the example above
19278 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19279 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19280 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19281 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19282 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19283
19284These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19285failures.
19286
19287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192888.3. Advanced logging options
19289-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019290
19291Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19292just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19293options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19294for more information about their usage.
19295
19296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19298------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019299
19300It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19301haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19302commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19303monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19304ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19305
19306 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19307 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19308 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19309 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19310
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019311 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19312 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019313
19314 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19315 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19316 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19317
19318
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193198.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19320----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019321
19322The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19323what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19324or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019325"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019326just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19327log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19328after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19329is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19330with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19331with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19332
19333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193348.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19335------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019336
19337Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19338for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19339"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19340retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19341raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19342a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19343file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19344you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19345"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19346
19347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193488.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
19349--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019350
19351Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
19352multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
19353them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
19354"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
19355logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
19356error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
19357and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
19358too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
19359useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
19360alternative.
19361
19362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193638.4. Timing events
19364------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019365
19366Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
19367reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
19368the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
19369frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019370mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
19371addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
19372
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019373Timings events in HTTP mode:
19374
19375 first request 2nd request
19376 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
19377 t tr t tr ...
19378 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
19379 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
19380 :<---- Tq ---->: :
19381 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019382 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010019383 :<--------- Ta --------->:
19384
19385Timings events in TCP mode:
19386
19387 TCP session
19388 |<----------------->|
19389 t t
19390 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19391 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19392 |<------ Tt ------->|
19393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019394 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019395 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019396 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19397 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19398 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019399 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019400 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19401 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19402 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19403 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019405 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19406 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19407 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019408 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19409 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19410 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19411 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19412 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19413 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019414
19415 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19416 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19417 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19418 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19419 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19420 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19421 request typed by hand during a test.
19422
19423 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19424 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019425 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019426 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19427 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19428 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19429 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019430
19431 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19432 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19433 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19434 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19435 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19436
19437 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19438 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19439 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19440 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19441 connection never established.
19442
19443 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19444 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19445 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19446 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19447 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19448 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19449 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19450 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19451 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19452 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19453 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19454
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019455 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19456 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19457 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19458 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19459 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19460 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19461
19462 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19463
19464 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19465 "Ta" can never be negative.
19466
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019467 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19468 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019469 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19470 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019471 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019472
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019473 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019474
19475 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019476 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19477 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019478
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019479 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19480 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19481 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19482 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19483 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19484 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19485 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19486 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19487
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019488These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19489protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19490that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019491due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19492"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19493that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019494
19495Most common cases :
19496
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019497 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19498 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19499 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19500 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19501 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19502 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19503 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19504 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19505 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19506 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19507 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019508 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019509
19510 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19511 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19512 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19513 of ms on remote networks.
19514
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019515 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19516 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19517 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019518
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019519 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19520 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19521 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19522 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19523 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19524 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19525 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19526 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19527 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019528
19529Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19530
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019531 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019532 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019533 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019534
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019535 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019536 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19537 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19538
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019539 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019540 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19541 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19542 flags.
19543
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019544 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19545 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019546 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19547 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19548 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19549 the client connection was maintained open.
19550
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019551 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019552 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019553 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019554 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19555
19556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195578.5. Session state at disconnection
19558-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019559
19560TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19561"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
195622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19563each of which has a special meaning :
19564
19565 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19566 session to terminate :
19567
19568 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19569
19570 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19571 server explicitly refused it.
19572
19573 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19574 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19575 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19576 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019577 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019578
19579 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19580 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019581
19582 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19583 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19584 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19585 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19586 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19587
19588 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19589 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19590 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19591 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19592 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19593
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019594 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19595 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19596
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019597 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19598 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19599 backup connections when going up.
19600
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019601 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19602
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019603 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19604 send or receive data.
19605
19606 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19607 send or receive data.
19608
19609 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19610 with nothing left in the buffers.
19611
19612 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19613
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019614 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019615 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19616
19617 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19618 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19619 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19620 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19621 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19622
19623 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19624 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19625
19626 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19627 server (HTTP only).
19628
19629 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19630
19631 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19632 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19633 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19634
19635 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19636 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19637 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19638
19639 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19640
19641 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19642 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19643
19644 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19645 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19646 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19647
19648 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19649 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019650 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19651 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019652
19653 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19654 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19655 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19656 another server.
19657
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019658 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019659 server.
19660
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019661 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19662 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19663 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19664 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19665
19666 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19667 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19668 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19669 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19670
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019671 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19672 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19673 "use-server" rule).
19674
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019675 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19676
19677 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19678 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19679
19680 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19681
19682 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19683 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19684 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19685
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019686 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19687 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019688 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019689 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19690 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019692 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19693
19694 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19695 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19696
19697 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19698
19699 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19700
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019701The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19702was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019703helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19704starvation, attacks, etc...
19705
19706The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19707alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19708easier finding and understanding.
19709
19710 Flags Reason
19711
19712 -- Normal termination.
19713
19714 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19715 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19716 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19717 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19718
19719 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19720 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19721 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19722 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19723 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19724 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019726 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19727 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019728 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019729
19730 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19731 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19732 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19733
19734 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19735 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19736 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19737 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19738 the server takes too long to respond.
19739
19740 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19741 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19742 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19743 long a time to respond.
19744
19745 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19746 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19747 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19748 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019749 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19750 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019751
19752 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19753 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19754 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19755 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19756 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019757 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019758 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19759 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19760 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19761 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19762 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19763 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19764 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19765 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019766 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019767 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19768 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19769 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019770
19771 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19772 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019773 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19774 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19775 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19776 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019777
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019778 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19779 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019781 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019782 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19783 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019784 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019785 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19786 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19787
19788 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19789 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19790 503 or 504 here.
19791
19792 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19793 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19794 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19795 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19796 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19797
19798 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19799 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019800 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019801 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19802 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19803
19804 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19805 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19806 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19807 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19808 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19809 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19810 between haproxy and the server.
19811
19812 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19813 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19814 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19815 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19816 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19817 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19818 solution is to fix the application.
19819
19820 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19821 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19822 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19823 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19824 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19825 external attacks.
19826
19827 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19828 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019829 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019830 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19831 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19832
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019833 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19834 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19835 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019836 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019837 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019838
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019839 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19840 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19841 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19842 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019843 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19844 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19845 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19846 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19847 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019848
19849 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19850 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19851 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19852 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19853
19854 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19855 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19856 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19857 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19858
19859 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19860 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19861 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19862 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19863
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019864The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19865persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19866important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19867re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19868
19869 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19870
19871 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19872 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19873 set on a GET request.
19874
19875 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19876 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019877 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019878 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19879
19880 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19881 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19882 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19883
19884 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19885 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19886 already got a cookie.
19887
19888 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19889 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19890 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19891 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19892 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19893
19894 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19895 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19896 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19897
19898 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19899 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19900 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19901
19902 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19903 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19904
19905 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19906 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19907 then advertised in the response.
19908
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199108.6. Non-printable characters
19911-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
19913In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19914consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19915converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19916prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19917being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19918escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19919is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19920'}' when logging headers.
19921
19922Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19923issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19924containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19925
19926Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19927the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19928performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19929
19930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199318.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19932---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019933
19934Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19935achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019936section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019937cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19938the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19939the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019940locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019941not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19942user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19943a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19944wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19945
19946 Examples :
19947 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19948 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19949
19950 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19951 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19952
19953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199548.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19955---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019956
19957Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19958proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19959the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19960server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19961
19962Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19963response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019964section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019965
19966It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019967time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19968appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019969are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19970and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19971follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19972request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19973in the logs.
19974
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019975As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19976frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19977an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19978
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019979 Example :
19980 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19981 listen proxy-out
19982 mode http
19983 option httplog
19984 option logasap
19985 log global
19986 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19987
19988 # log the name of the virtual server
19989 capture request header Host len 20
19990
19991 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19992 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19993
19994 # log the beginning of the referrer
19995 capture request header Referer len 20
19996
19997 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19998 capture response header Server len 20
19999
20000 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20001 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20002
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020003 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020004 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20005
20006 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20007 capture response header Via len 20
20008
20009 # log the URL location during a redirection
20010 capture response header Location len 20
20011
20012 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20013 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20014 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20015 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20016 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20017
20018 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20019 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20020 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20021 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020022 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020023
20024 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20025 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20026 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20027 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20028 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020029 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020030
20031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200328.9. Examples of logs
20033---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020034
20035These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20036them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20037reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20038
20039 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20040 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20041 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20042
20043 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20044 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20045
20046 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20047 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20048 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20049
20050 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20051 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20052
20053 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20054 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20055 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20056
20057 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020058 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020059 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20060 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20061
20062 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20063 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20064 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20065
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020066 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20067 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20068 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20069 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20070 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20071 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020072
20073 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020074 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075
20076 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20077 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20078 Nothing was sent to any server.
20079
20080 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20081 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20082
20083 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20084 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020085 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020086 send a 408 return code to the client.
20087
20088 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20089 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20090
20091 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20092 5 seconds ("c----").
20093
20094 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20095 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020096 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020097
20098 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020099 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20101 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20102 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20103 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20104 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020105
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200201079. Supported filters
20108--------------------
20109
20110Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20111accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20112unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20113
20114See also : "filter"
20115
201169.1. Trace
20117----------
20118
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020119filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020120
20121 Arguments:
20122 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20123 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20124
20125 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
20126 the client and the server. By default, this filter
20127 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
20128 only parses a random amount of the available data.
20129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020130 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020131 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20132 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20133 amount of the parsed data.
20134
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020135 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020136
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020137This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20138callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20139information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20140filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20141
20142Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20143tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20144a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20145
20146
201479.2. HTTP compression
20148---------------------
20149
20150filter compression
20151
20152The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20153keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020154when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20155fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20156done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20157explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20158filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20159listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20160order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020161
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020162See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20163 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020164
20165
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200201669.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20167--------------------------------------------
20168
20169filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20170
20171 Arguments :
20172
20173 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20174 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20175 parsed.
20176
20177 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20178 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20179 part must be placed in its own scope.
20180
20181The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20182external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020183streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020184exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20185also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20186
20187SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20188the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20189
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020190For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020191"doc/SPOE.txt".
20192
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100201939.4. Cache
20194----------
20195
20196filter cache <name>
20197
20198 Arguments :
20199
20200 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20201
20202The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20203"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020204cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020205other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20206case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20207is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20208filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020209listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20210order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020211
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020212See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20213 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20214
20215
202169.5. Fcgi-app
20217-------------
20218
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020219filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020220
20221 Arguments :
20222
20223 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20224
20225The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20226request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20227reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20228used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20229implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20230used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20231fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20232used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20233order.
20234
20235See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20236 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20237
20238
2023910. FastCGI applications
20240-------------------------
20241
20242HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20243feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20244the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20245FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20246servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20247FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20248backend.
20249
20250HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20251application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20252connection.
20253
2025410.1. Setup
20255-----------
20256
2025710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20258--------------------------
20259
20260fcgi-app <name>
20261 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20262 document root must be defined.
20263
20264acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20265 Declare or complete an access list.
20266
20267 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20268 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20269 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20270 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20271 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20272
20273docroot <path>
20274 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20275 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20276 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20277
20278index <script-name>
20279 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20280 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20281 is an optional setting.
20282
20283 Example :
20284 index index.php
20285
20286log-stderr global
20287log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
20288 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
20289 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20290
20291 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20292 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20293
20294pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20295 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20296 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20297 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20298
20299 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20300 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20301 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20302 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20303
20304 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20305 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20306
20307path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020308 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020309 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20310 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20311 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20312 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20313 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20314 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20315 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020316
20317 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020318 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020319 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
20320 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
20321 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
20322 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020323
20324 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020325 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
20326 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020327
20328option get-values
20329no option get-values
20330 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
20331
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020332 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020333 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
20334
20335 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
20336 application will accept.
20337
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020020338 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
20339 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020340
20341 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050020342 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020343 option is disabled.
20344
20345 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
20346 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
20347 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
20348 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
20349 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
20350 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
20351
20352option keep-conn
20353no option keep-conn
20354 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
20355 sending a response.
20356
20357 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
20358 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
20359
20360option max-reqs <reqs>
20361 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
20362 accept.
20363
20364 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
20365 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
20366 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
20367 to 1.
20368
20369option mpxs-conns
20370no option mpxs-conns
20371 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
20372
20373 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
20374 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
20375
20376set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20377 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
20378 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
20379 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
20380 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20381
20382 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
20383 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
20384 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
20385
20386 Example :
20387 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20388 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20389
20390 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20391
20392
2039310.1.2. Proxy section
20394---------------------
20395
20396use-fcgi-app <name>
20397 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20398
20399 Arguments :
20400 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20401
20402 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20403 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20404 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20405 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20406 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20407
20408 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20409 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20410 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20411 application are evaluated.
20412
20413
2041410.1.3. Example
20415---------------
20416
20417 frontend front-http
20418 mode http
20419 bind *:80
20420 bind *:
20421
20422 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20423 default_backend back-static
20424
20425 backend back-static
20426 mode http
20427 server www A.B.C.D:80
20428
20429 backend back-dynamic
20430 mode http
20431 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20432 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20433
20434 fcgi-app php-fpm
20435 log-stderr global
20436 option keep-conn
20437
20438 docroot /var/www/my-app
20439 index index.php
20440 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20441
20442
2044310.2. Default parameters
20444------------------------
20445
20446A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20447the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020448script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020449applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20450
20451 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20452 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20453 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20454 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20455 | | |
20456 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20457 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20458 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20459 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20460 | | application. |
20461 | | |
20462 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20463 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20464 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20465 | | |
20466 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20467 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20468 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20469 | | the application's configuration. |
20470 | | |
20471 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20472 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20473 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20474 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20475 | | |
20476 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20477 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20478 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20479 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20480 | | be defined. |
20481 | | |
20482 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20483 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20484 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20485 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20486 | | is not set too. |
20487 | | |
20488 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20489 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20490 | | set. |
20491 | | |
20492 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20493 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20494 | | the request. |
20495 | | |
20496 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20497 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20498 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20499 | | |
20500 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20501 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20502 | | script to process the request. |
20503 | | |
20504 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20505 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20506 | | |
20507 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20508 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20509 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20510 | | |
20511 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20512 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20513 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20514 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20515 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20516 | | |
20517 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20518 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20519 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20520 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20521 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20522 | | side. |
20523 | | |
20524 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20525 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20526 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20527 | | connected to. |
20528 | | |
20529 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20530 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20531 | | |
20532 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20533 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20534 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20535 | | |
20536 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20537
20538
2053910.3. Limitations
20540------------------
20541
20542The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20543way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20544during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20545establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20546application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20547or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20548message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20549these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20550and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20551
20552Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20553request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20554requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20555
20556About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20557into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20558fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20559"http-request" ones.
20560
20561Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20562FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20563processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20564must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20565here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020567/*
20568 * Local variables:
20569 * fill-column: 79
20570 * End:
20571 */